MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Printer SHARP - Free user manual and instructions

Find the device manual for free MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV SHARP in PDF.

📄 201 pages English EN 💬 AI Question
Notice SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - page 3
View the manual : Français FR English EN

Questions des utilisateurs sur MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV SHARP

0 question sur cet appareil. Repondez a celles que vous connaissez ou posez la votre.

Poser une nouvelle question sur cet appareil

L'email reste privé : il sert seulement à vous prévenir si quelqu'un répond à votre question.

Aucune question pour l'instant. Soyez le premier à en poser une.

Download the instructions for your Printer in PDF format for free! Find your manual MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - SHARP and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV by SHARP.

USER MANUAL MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV SHARP

[1] PRODUCT OUTLINE 1-1
[2] SPECIFICATIONS 2-1
[3] CONSUMABLE PARTS 3-1
[4] EXTERNAL VIEW AND INTERNAL STRUCTURE 4-1
[5]ADJUSTMENTS 5-1
[6] SIMULATION 6-1
[7] SELF DIAG AND TROUBLE CODE 7-1
[8] MAINTENANCE. 8-1
[9]FIRMAWARE UPDATE 9-1
[10] ELECTRICAL SECTION 10-1

Parts marked with “ ” are important for maintaining the safety of the set. Be sure to replace these parts with specified ones for maintaining the safety and performance of the set.

CONTENTS

NOTE FOR SERVICING

  1. Warning for servicing..
  2. Precautions for servicing
  3. Note for repairing/replacing the LSU

[1] PRODUCT OUTLINE

  1. Line of machines and options 1-1

[2] SPECIFICATIONS

  1. Basic function 2-1

[3] CONSUMABLE PARTS

  1. Supply system table. 3-1
  2. Maintenance parts list 3-2
  3. Developer/Drum life end definition.. 3-3
  4. Production number identification 3-3
  5. Environment conditions 3-3

[4] EXTERNAL VIEW AND INTERNAL STRUCTURE

  1. External view 4-1
  2. Internal structure 4-2
  3. Operation panel 4-3
    4.RSPF 4-4
  4. Sensor 4-5
  5. Switch 4-5
  6. Solenoid/Clutch 4-6
    8.Drive motor. 4-6
    9.Lamp 4-7
    10.Fan/Filter 4-7
    11.PWB. 4-8
  7. Roller 4-8

[5] ADJUSTMENTS

  1. Adjustment item list. 5-1
  2. Details of adjustment. 5-1

[6] SIMULATION

  1. General 6-1
  2. Simulation code list 6-3
  3. Details of simulation 6-6

[7] SELF DIAG AND TROUBLE CODE

  1. Trouble code list 7-1
  2. Details of trouble code 7-2

[8] MAINTENANCE

  1. Maintenance list 8-1
  2. Details of Maintenance 8-3
  3. Other related items 8-31

[9] FIRMWARE UPDATE

  1. Firmware update procedure 9-1

[10] ELECTRICAL SECTION

  1. Block diagram 10-1
  2. Actual wiring chart. 10-2
  3. Signal list. 10-9

NOTE FOR SERVICING

This Service Manual uses some photographs to assure safe operation. Please understand the meanings of photographs before servicing.

WARNING: If this WARNING should be ignored, a serious danger to life or a serious injury may result.
CAUTION: If this CAUTION should be ignored, injury or damage to property could result.

1. Warning for servicing

1) Be sure to connect the power cord only to a power outlet that meets the specified voltage and current requirements. Avoid complex wiring, which may lead to a fire or an electric shock.
2) If there is any abnormality such as smoke or an abnormal smell, interrupt the job and disconnect the power plug. It may cause a fire or an electric shock.
3) Be sure the machine is properly grounded. Failure to ground the machine properly may result in an electric shock or fire. To protect the machine and the power unit from lightening, grounding must be made.
4) When connecting the ground wire, never connect it to the following points as it may cause an explosion, fire, or an electric shock:

Gas tube
Lightning conductor
- A water pipe or a water faucet, which is not recognized as a grounding object by the authorities.
- Grounding wire for telephone line

5) Do not damage, break, or stress the power cord. Do not put heavy objects on the power cord. Do not bend or pull the cord forcefully. It may cause a fire or electric shock.
6) Keep the power cable away from a heat source.

Do not insert the power plug with dust on it into a power outlet. It may cause a fire or an electric shock.

7) Do not put a receptacle with water in it or a metal piece which may drop inside the machine. It may cause a fire or an electric shock.
8) Do not touch the power plug, insert a telephone jack, perform service or operate the machine with wet or oil hands. It may cause an electric shock.

2. Precautions for servicing

1) When servicing, disconnect the power plug, the printer cable, the network cable, and the telephone line from the machine, except when performing the communication test, etc. It may cause an injury or an electric shock.
2) There is a high temperature area inside the machine. Use extreme care when servicing.
3) There is a high voltage section inside the machine which may cause an electric shock. Be careful when servicing.
4) Do not disassemble the laser unit. Do not insert a reflective material such as a screwdriver in the laser beam path. It may damage eyes by reflection of laser beams.
5) When servicing the machine while operating, be careful not to make contact with chains, belts, gear, and any other moving parts.
6) Do not leave the machine with the cabinet disassembled.
Do not allow any person other than a serviceman to touch inside the machine. It may cause an electric shock, a burn, or an injury.
7) When servicing, do not breathe toner, developer, and ink excessively. Do not get them in the eyes. If toner, developer, or ink enters you eyes, wash it away with water immediately, and consult a doctor if necessary.
8) The machine has got sharp edges inside. Be careful not to damage fingers when servicing.
9) Do not throw toner or a toner cartridge in a fire. Otherwise, toner may pop and burn you.
10) When replacing the lithium battery on the PWB, use only the specified battery. If a battery of different specifications is used, it may not be compatible and cause breakdown or malfunction of the machine.
11) When carrying an electric unit or a PWB, use an anti-static (electricity) bag. Failure to do so may cause component failure or machine malfunction.

3. Note for repairing/replacing the LSU

When repairing or replacing, be sure to observe the following items.

1) When repairing or replacing the LSU, be sure to disconnect the power plug from the power outlet.
2) When repairing or replacing the LSU, follow the procedures described in this Service Manual.
3) When checking the operations after repairing the LSU, keep all the parts including the cover installed and perform the operation check.
4) Do not modify the LSU.
5) When visually checking the inside of the machine for the operation check, be careful not to allow laser beams to enter the eyes.

If the above precaution is neglected or an undesignated work is performed, safety may not be assured.

[1] PRODUCT OUTLINE

1. Line of machines and options

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Line of machines and options - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Line of machines and options - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Line of machines and options - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Line of machines and options - 4

[2] SPECIFICATIONS

1. Basic function

A. Base engine

(1) Type

TypeDesktop

(2) Engine composition

Photoconductor kindOPC drum (Drum dia. 30mm)
Copying methodElectronic photo (Laser)
Developing systemDry, 2-component magnetic brush development
Charging systemSawtooth charging
Transfer systemTransfer roller system
Cleaning systemContact blade system
Fusing systemHeat roller
Toner supply methodToner supply by front cover open
Waste toner disposalToner cartridge collection

(3) Dimensions / Weight

External dimensions (W x D x H)OC model: 623 x 628 x 668mm RSPF model: 623 x 628 x 788mm
Occupied dimensions (W x D) (when the manual paper feed tray is extended)898 x 628mm
WeightAbout 46kg

(4)Warmup

Warm-up time23 sec or less (26-sheet model) 25 sec or less (31-sheet model)
Pre-heatYes
Jam recovery timeAbout 10sec, excluding fusing warmup, toner control, etc.

Conditions: Leaving for 60 sec after door open, standard conditions, polygon stop.

(5) First copy time

26-sheet model31-sheet model
Platen4.8 sec4.5 sec
RSPF9.3 sec or less
  • Measuring conditions: When paper of A4 or 8.5" x 11" is fed from the machine tray, with the polygon rotating.

(6) Engine resolution

Writing resolution600 x 600dpi
Smoothing (Print)1200dpi (equivalent) x 600dpi
GradationWriting: Binary

(7) Printable range

Max. print sizeAB series: 416 x 293mm (600dpi: 9826dot x 6920dot) Inch series: 428 x 275mm (600dpi: 10110dot x 6496dot)
Void area image lossFront/Rear: Less than 4mm Right/Left total: Less than 6mm at actual (100%) size

(8) Engine speed (ppm)

TrayPaper size26-sheet model31-sheet model
Tray 1-4A31517
B4/8.5 x 131720
A4/B5/A5/8.5 x 11/5.5 x 8.5/16K2631
A4R/8.5 x 11R/16KR1824
B5R21
11 x 171417
8.5 x 141620
8K19
Manual paper feedA31417
8.5 x 131720
B41619
A4/B5/A5/8.5 x 11/5.5 x 8.5/16K2327
A4R/8.5 x 11R1922
16KR23
B5R2124
11 x 171416
8.5 x 141619

(9) Power source

Voltage/Current220 - 240V 8A
Frequency50/60Hz
Power source codeInlet type
Power switch1 power source

(10) Power consumption

Maximum rated power consumption1.45kw
Shift time to sleep modeDefault (1 minute)

(11) Memory

Local MemoryStandard32MB
Expansion512MB x 2
Max.1056MB

B. Controller board

(1) Controller board

SPLC board
InterfaceEthernetNo
USB 2.0 DeviceFull Speed 1slot
MemoryNo
Memory expansion slot---

C. Operation panel

TypeDot matrix LCD, touch panel
SizeMonochrome H-VGA 8.1"
Display dot number640 x 240 (H-VGA)
LCD drive display area192 x 72mm
LCD backlightFluorescent lamp backlight system
LCD contrast adjustmentYes

D. Scanner section

(1) Resolution/Gradation

Reading resolution (dpi)Copy mode
Platen400 x 600dpi
RSPF400 x 600dpi
Transmission resolution (dpi)FAX transmission mode
Select modeNormal textFine textSuper fine textUltra fine text
Input resolution: OC203.2 x 293.4203.2 x 293.4203.2 x 391.2406.4 x 586.7
Input resolution: RSPF203.2 x 293.4203.2 x 293.4203.2 x 391.2406.4 x 586.7
Transmission resolution203.2 x 97.8203.2 x 195.6203.2 x 391406.4 x 391
Half toneNoYesYesYes
Reading gradation256 gradations
Exposure lampElectrodeless xenon lamp
Output gradationBinary

(2) Document table

TypeDocument table fixed type (Flat bed)
Scanning area297 x 431.8mm
Original standard positionLeft bottom reference
DetectionYes
Detection sizeInch seriesAutomatic setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5 Manual setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4, A4R
AB seriesAutomatic setting A3, B4, A4, A4R, A5 Manual setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, A3, B4, A4, A4R, A5

(3) Automatic document feeder

TypeRSPF (Automatic duplex document feeder unit)
Scan speedWhen in single copyWhen in duplex copy
Copy31-sheet model: 27 sheets/min (400 x 600dpi) 26-sheet model: 26 sheets/min (400 x 600dpi)31-sheet model: 13.6 side/min (400 x 600dpi) 26-sheet model: 13.6 side/min (400 x 600dpi)
Fax40 sheets/min (Normal text, A4R)17 sheets/min (Normal text, A4R)
Document set directionFace-up reference
Document standard positionCenter reference
Document transport systemSheet through system
Document sizeAB series: A3 - A5 Inch series: 11 x 17 - 5.5 x 8.5
Document weightSingle face: 35 - 128g/m², 9 - 34 lbs, Duplex: 52 - 105g/m², 13.9 - 28 lbs
Max. loading capacity of documents100 sheets (90g/m²) Paper thickness of 13mm or less can be set.
Transport disable documentOHP, perforated documents, photo, catalogue, second original sheet, tracing paper, carbon paper, heat-sensitive paper, wrinkled paper, folded or broken paper, pasted or cut-away paper, documents of many perforated holes (2-hole, 3-hole documents can be used), document printed by an ink ribbon
DetectionYes
Detection sizeInch seriesAutomatic setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4 Manual setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4, A4R
AB seriesAutomatic setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 11, A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5 Manual setting 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, A3, B4, A4, A4R, A5
Multi copyS-S, S-D, D-D, D-S
Mixed paper feedEnable (Same width only)

E. Paper feed section

TypePaper feed tray + Multi manual paper feed (Expanded up to 4 trays by installing options.)
Paper feed methodPaper is fed from the above by the front loading system.
Details of paper feed sectionTray1Tray2Manual paper feed tray
Paper capacityStandard paper (80g/m2)500 sheets100 sheets
Paper sizeA3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13, 8.5 x 11, 8.5x11R, 5.5 x 8.5, 8K, 16K, 16KRA3, B4, A4, A4R, B5R, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14 (216 x 356), 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 8K, 16KRA3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5R, A5, B6R, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14 (216 x 356), 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 7.25 x 10.5R, 5.5 x 8.5, 8K, 16K, 16KR, A6R, Envelope*1
Paper size detectionNoYes
Allowable paper type and weight for paper feed56 - 105g/m2/15 - 28lbs BondMulti paper feed: Standard paper (56 - 128g/m2) Special paper, heavy paper (max. 200g/m2) Single paper feed: Standard paper, special paper, second original, heavy paper (max. 200g/m2), 56- 200g/m2 (14 - 54lbs)
Paper typeStandard paper (56 - 80g/m2) Normal paper (60 - 105g/m2) Letterhead Color paper• Standard paper: 100 sheets (56 - 80g/m2) • Recycled paper/coarse paper: 100 sheets • Heavy paper (max. 200g/m2): 30 sheets • OHP/Label sheet/gift wrapping paper: 40 sheets • Label sheet: 40 sheets • Envelope (AB series: 10 sheets, Inch series: 5 sheets)
Paper size setting when shippingInch series8.5 x 11---
AB seriesA4---
Paper remaining detectionNo (paper presence only)
  • 1: Supported envelope kinds: Commercial10 (4 - 1/8" x 9 - 1/2"), International DL (110mm x 220mm), International C5 (162mm x 229mm)

F. Paper exit section

(1) Center tray of main unit

Paper exit position/systemMain unit top surface face-down paper exit
Paper exit capacity500 sheets (A4, 8.5 x 11, 80g/m2paper)
Paper exit paper size/ kindAll kinds of paper which can be fed
Shifter functionYes
Paper remaining detection for paper exitYes

G. Copy functions

(1) Copy magnification ratio

Copy magnification ratioAB series25%, 50%, 70%, 81%, 86%, 100%, 115%, 122%, 141%, 200%, 400%
Inch series25%, 50%, 64%, 77%, 100%, 121%, 129%, 200%, 400%
Zoom25 - 400% (Restriction by the document feeder unit: 50 - 200%)

(2) Density/copy image quality process

Exposure modeBinary: Automatic, Text, Text/Photo, Photo
Number of manual steps5 steps

(3) Duplex

SystemSwitchback system
Paper sizeA3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13, 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R
Type and weight of paper which can be passed56 - 105g/m2/15 - 21.3 lbs Bond Duplex print from manual paper feed can be made. (Except for heavy paper, OHP sheet, and other special paper)
  • When duplex printing is continued in a certain level of temperature, the printing speed may be reduced in order to prevent an abnormal temperature rise in the machine.

(4) Copy functions

Automatic paper selection
Automatic magnification ratio selection
Vertical/horizontal independent magnification ratio
Paper type selection
Auto tray switching
Rotation copy
Electronic sort
Job reservation (only during warm-up)
Program call-out/registration (10 items)
Preheat function
Auto power shut off function
User management (100 items)
Mixed documents feed (MIX only)
Binding margin (Left/Right/Upper)
Edge erase/Center erase (Center/Edge/Center + Edge)
1 set 2 copy
Cover paper/Insert paper (Cover/Back cover only)
Multi shot (2 in 1/4 in 1) (Centering available)
Card shot (Centering available)
Pamphlet mode (Centering available)
Duplex copy direction switching
Large volume document mode
Black/white reverse (except for UK)
Stream feeding mode (ON/OFF switch by the system setting)

H. Printer function

(1) Platform

IBM PC/AT
Macintosh

(2) Support OS

OSSPLC
Windows2000Yes
XP
XP x64
Server 2003No
Server 2003 x64
VistaYes
Vista x64
Server 2008No
Server 2008 x64
Mac9.0 - 9.2.2
X 10.2.8
X 10.3.9
X 10.4.11
X 10.5 - 10.5.6

I. Environmental conditions

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Environmental conditions - 1

Standard environmental conditionsTemperature20 - 25°C
Humidity65 ± 5%RH
Usage environmental conditionsTemperature10 - 35°C
Humidity20 - 85%RH
Atmospheric pressure590 - 1013 hPa (height: 0 - 2000m)

[3] CONSUMABLE PARTS

1. Supply system table

A. East Europe/Russia

No.ItemContentLifeModel nameRemarks
1Toner cartridge (black)Toner cartridge (With IC chip) ×1 (Toner; Net 700g)33KMX-312GTLife setting by A4 (8.5"×11") 6% document Default: Toner save mode
2Developer (black)Developer ×1 (Developer; Net 300g)26cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312GV
3DrumDrum ×126cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312GR

B. Asia Subsidiaries

No.ItemContentLifeModel nameRemarks
1Toner cartridge (black)Toner cartridge (With IC chip) ×1 (Toner; Net 700g)33KMX-312ATLife setting by A4 (8.5"×11") 6% document Default: Toner save mode
2Developer (black)Developer ×1 (Developer; Net 300g)26cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312AV
3DrumDrum ×126cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312AR

C. SMEF/Agent

No.ItemContentLifeModel nameRemarks
1Toner cartridge (black)Toner cartridge (With IC chip) ×1 (Toner; Net 700g)33KMX-312FTLife setting by A4 (8.5"×11") 6% document Default: Toner save mode
2Developer (black)Developer ×1 (Developer; Net 300g)26cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312FV
3DrumDrum ×126cpm: 75K 31cpm: 100KMX-312FR

2. Maintenance parts list

A. East Europe/Russia/SMEF

No.ItemContentLifeModel nameRemarks
1Upper heat roller kitUpper heat roller ×1150KAR-310UH
Fuser gear ×1
Upper heat roller bearing ×2
Upper cleaning pad ×1
Fusing separation pawl (upper) ×4
Thermistor cleaning pad ×2
2Lower heat roller kitLower heat roller ×1300KMX-311LH
Fusing separation pawl (lower) ×4
Fuser bearing (lower) ×2
3150K PM kitDrum separation pawl unit ×2150KMX-311KA
Transfer roller unit ×1
DV blade ×1
DV side sheet F ×1
DV side sheet R ×1
Toner filter unit ×1
4MC unitMC unit ×1026cpm: 75K (×10)MX-311MC
31cpm: 100K (×10)
5Cleaner bladeCleaner blade ×1026cpm: 75K (×10)MX-311CB
31cpm: 100K (×10)
6Drum frame unitDrum frame unit ×126cpm: 225KMX-311DU* The life of the toner reception seat attached to the drum frame is 300K, and it can be used up to 3 times. (Supplied as a drum frame unit.)
31cpm: 300K
7Transfer roller unitTransfer roller unit ×1150KMX-311TX
8Staple cartridgeStaple cartridge ×35000 staples ×3MX-SCX1
  • The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.

B. Asia Subsidiaries/Agent

No.ItemContentLifeModel nameRemarks
1Upper heat roller kitUpper heat roller x1150KAR-310UH
Fuser gear x1
Upper heat roller bearing x2
Upper cleaning pad x1
Fusing separation pawl (upper) x4
Thermistor cleaning pad x2
2Lower heat roller kitLower heat roller x1300KMX-311LH
Fusing separation pawl (lower) x4
Fuser bearing (lower) x2
3150K PM kitDrum separation pawl unit x2150KMX-311KA
Transfer roller unit x1
DV blade x1
DV side sheet F x1
DV side sheet R x1
Toner filter unit x1
4MC unitMC unit x1026cpm: 75K (×10)MX-311MC
31cpm: 100K (×10)
5Cleaner bladeCleaner blade x1026cpm: 75K (×10)MX-311CB
31cpm: 100K (×10)
6Drum frame unitDrum frame unit x126cpm: 225KMX-311DU* The life of the toner reception seat attached to the drum frame is 300K, and it can be used up to 3 times. (Supplied as a drum frame unit.)
31cpm: 300K
7Staple cartridgeStaple cartridge x35000 staples x3MX-SCX1
  • The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.

3. Developer/Drum life end definition

When the developer/drum counter reaches the specified level.

When the developer/drum rpm reaches the specified level.

When either of the above reached the specified level, it is judged as life end.

In an actual case, when correction or warm-up operation is performed as well as output operation, the developer and the drum rotates.

Therefore, the developer/drum consuming level cannot be determined only by the copy/print quantity. When, therefore, the rpm reaches the specified level, it is judged as life end.

To check the drum and developer life, use SIM22-1.

Developer/drum counterNumber of rotations (Rotations)
Developer/drum26cpm model31cpm model550K
75K100K

4. Production number identification

The label on the toner cartridge shows the date of production.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Production number identification - 1
Production place (1 digits)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Production number identification - 1

12345678

The lot number is of 8 digits. Each digit indicates the content as follows. The number is printed on the right under side of the back surface of the developer bag.

1 Alphabet Indicates the production factory.
2 Number Indicates the production year.
3,4 Number Indicates the production month.
5,6 Number Indicates the production day.
7 Hyphen
8 Number Indicates the production lot.

The laser print indicates the model conformity code and the date (year, month, day) of production.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Production number identification - 1

12345

1 Alphabet Indicates the model conformity code. L for this model.
2 Number Indicates the end digit of the production year.
3 Number or X, Y, Z Indicates the month of packing. X stands for October, Y November, and Z December.
4,5 Number Indicates the day of the month of packing.

5. Environment conditions

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Environment conditions - 1
(Temperature)

Standard environmental conditionsTemperature20 - 25°C
Humidity65 ± 5%RH
Usage environmental conditionsTemperature10 - 35°C
Humidity20 - 85%RH
Atmospheric pressure590 - 1013 hPa (height: 0 - 2000m)
Storage periodToner/Developer: 24 months from the manufactured month (Production lot) under unsealed state Drum: 36 months from the manufactured month under unsealed state

[4] EXTERNAL VIEW AND INTERNAL STRUCTURE

1. External view

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - External view - 1

No.NameFunction/Operation
1Document feeder trayPlace the original(s) that you wish to scan face up here.
2Original guidesAdjust to the size of the originals.
3Document feeder coverOpen to remove misfed originals.
4Reversing trayPull out to remove misfed originals.
5Exit areaOriginals exit the machine here after copying.
6Document transport coverOpen to remove misfed originals.
7Document transport cover knobPull to open the document transport cover.
8Document glassPlace an original that you wish to scan face down here.
9Power switchPress to turn the machine power on and off.
10HandlesUse to move the machine.
11Operation panelContains operation keys and the touch panel.
12Job separator tray (Upper tray) (optional)Print jobs and received faxes are delivered to this tray.
13Center trayFinished copies are delivered to the center tray.
14Front coverOpen to remove paper misfeeds and perform machine maintenance.
15Paper traysEach tray holds 500 sheets of copy paper.
16Upper right side coverOpen to remove misfeeds when an optional job separator tray kit or a optional finisher is installed.
17Side coverOpen to remove misfeeds.
18Side cover handlePull to open the side cover.
19Bypass tray paper guidesAdjust to the width of the paper.
20Bypass trayRegular paper and special paper (such as transparency film) can be fed from the bypass tray.
21Bypass tray extensionPull out the bypass tray extension before placing paper in the bypass tray.

2. Internal structure

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Internal structure - 1

No.NameFunction/OperationNote
1Toner cartridge lock release leverUse to unlock the toner cartridge.
2Toner cartridgeContains toner.
3Roller rotating knobTurn to remove misfed paper.
4Photoconductive drumCopy images are formed on the photoconductive drum.Do not touch the photoconductive drum (green portion). Doing so may damage the drum and cause smudges on copies.
5Fusing unit release leversTo remove a paper misfeed in the fusing unit, push up on these levers and remove the paper.The fusing unit is hot. Do not touch the fusing unit when removing misfed paper. Doing so may cause a burn or injury.
6Fusing unit paper guideOpen to remove misfed paper.

3. Operation panel

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Operation panel - 1

No.NameFunction/OperationNote
1Touch panelThe machine status, messages and touch keys are displayed on the panel. The display will show the status of printing, copying or network scanning according to the mode that is selected. For details see the next page.
2Mode select keys and indicatorsUse to change modes and the corresponding display on the touch panel.
[COPY] keyPress to select copy mode.
[PRINT] key/ONLINE indicator/DATA indicator[PRINT] key: Press to select print mode. • ONLINE indicator: Print jobs can be received when this indicator is lit. • DATA indicator: A print job is in memory. The indicator lights steadily while the job is held in memory, and blinks while the job is printed.
[FAX] key/LINE indicator/DATA indicator[FAX] key: Press to select fax mode when the fax option is installed. • LINE indicator: This lights up while faxes are being sent or received. • DATA indicator: Blinks when a fax has been received to memory and lights steadily when a fax is waiting in memory for transmission.When the fax option is installed.
3[JOB STATUS] keyPress to display the current job status.
4[SYSTEM SETTINGS] keyUse to adjust various settings of the machine including the contrast of the touch panel and administrator settings.
5Numeric keysUse to enter numeric values for various settings.
6[LOGOUT] key (⊗)When auditing mode is enabled, press this key after finishing a job to return the machine to account number entry standby.
7[#/P] key (⊕)Use this key to execute a job program in copy mode. The key is also used to dial in fax mode.
8[CLEAR] key (◎)Press to clear a copy number setting or cancel a job.
9[CLEAR ALL] key (⊕)Reset the settings to the initial settings.
10[START] key (⊗)Press in copy mode, scanner mode, or fax mode to begin copying, network scanning, or faxing. This key blinks when auto power shut mode has activated. Press the key to return to normal operation.
11[INTERRUPT] key (⊗)Use to perform an interrupt copy job.

4. RSPF

A. External view

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - External view - 1

No.Name
1Document set tray
2Document guide
3Document feed section cover
4Document transport section cover
5Document exit section

B. Internal structure

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Internal structure - 1

No.CodeNameTypeFunction/Operation
1EMPSDocument set sensorPhoto transmissionDetects presence of documents.
2FGODOpen/close sensorPhoto transmissionDetects open/close of the paper feed unit.
3DFCLPaper feed clutch
4DFDPaper entry sensorPhoto transmissionDetects presence of documents.
5RSOLPressure release solenoid
6CLHTransport clutch
7DTMSPF motorStepping motorDrives document feed on the tray, transport, and paper exit roller.
8GSOLGate solenoid
9Interface PWB
10DLS1Document length detection SW (Short)Photo transmissionDetects the document length on the tray.
11DLS2Document length detection SW (Long)Photo transmissionDetects the document length on the tray.
12OPCLSBook sensorPhoto transmissionDetects the SPF float.
13RDDPaper exit sensorPhoto transmissionDetects presence of documents.
14SWDDocument width sensorVolumeDetects the document width on the tray.

5. Sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Sensor - 1

No.NameCodeFunction and operation
1Mirror home position sensorMHPSMirror (scatterer) home position detection
2Document cover sensorOCSWDocument cover open/close detection
3Document size sensorDSIN3Document size detection(Inch series:PD3,4)(AB series:PD4,5)
42nd paper exit sensor(Option)POD22nd paper exit detection
52nd paper exit full detection sensor(Option)TOPF2nd paper exit section full detection
61st paper exit sensorPOD11st paper exit detection
7Shifter home position sensor(Except North America)SFTHPShifter home position sensor detection
8Paper exit sensor(DUP side)PPD2Paper exit detection
9ThermistorFusing temperature detection
101st tray (paper tray) detectionCD11st tray (paper tray) empty detection
11Manual feed paper entry sensorPPD1LSensor of paper entry from the manual paper feed tray, the 2nd/multi-tray desk, or the DUP
12Manual paper feed tray empty sensor 2MPLS2Manual feed tray position detection
13Manual paper feed tray empty sensor 1MPLS1Manual feed tray position detection
14Manual feed length detection sensor 1MPLD1Manual feed paper length detection
15Manual feed length detection sensor 2MPLD2Manual feed paper length detection
16Manual feed paper empty sensorMPEDManual feed paper empty detection
172nd tray paper pass sensorPFD22nd tray paper pass
No.NameCodeFunction and operation
182nd tray paper upper limit detection sensorLUD22nd tray paper upper limit detection
192nd tray paper empty sensorPED22nd tray paper empty detection
201st tray paper pass sensorPPD1H1st tray paper pass
211st tray paper upper limit detection sensorLUD11st tray paper upper limit detection
221st tray paper empty sensorPED11st tray paper empty detection
23Toner sensorToner density detection
24Center tray paper YES/NO sensorLOEMPCenter tray paper YES/NO detection
25Document size sensorDSINODocument size detection (Inch series: PD1, 2) (AB series: PD1 - 3)
26Reverse pass paper detection sensorDUP2Reverse pass detection

6. Switch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Switch - 1

No.NameCodeFunction and operation
1Right cabinet door switch (Option)DSWR0Right cabinet door open/close detection
2Door switchDSWR1Front door and side door open/close detection
32nd right door switchDSWR2Side door open/close detection
4Main switchPSSWMain power switch

7. Solenoid/Clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Solenoid/Clutch - 1

No.NameCodeFunction and operation
1Paper exit gate switching solenoid (Option)OGSPaper exit gate switcher
2PS clutchRRCMain unit paper feed
3Paper feed clutchCPFS1Paper feed roller drive
4Manual paper feed solenoidMPFSManual paper feed solenoid
5Paper feed transfer clutchTRC2Paper feed transfer clutch
62nd tray paper feed clutchCPFS2
72nd tray paper feed solenoidCPFC2Solenoid for the paper feed from the tray
8Paper feed solenoidCPFC1Solenoid for the paper feed from the tray
9Separation pawl solenoidPSPSSeparation pawl operation solenoid

8. Drive motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drive motor - 1

No.NameCodeFunction and operation
1Mirror motorMIRMOptical mirror base drive
2Shifter motor(Except North America)SFTMShifter drive
4Duplex motorDPXMDuplex paper switching and exit motor
5DUP-2 motorReverse pass for paper transport
6Main motorMMMain drive
7Tray lift-up motorLUM1Tray paper lift-up
8Tray lift-up motorLUM2Tray paper lift-up
9Toner motorTMToner supply

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drive motor - 2
9. Lamp

No.NameFunction and operation
1Copy lampImage radiation lamp
2Heater lampFusing heat lamp

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drive motor - 3
10. Fan/Filter

No.NameCodeFunction and operation
1Cooling fanVFMCools the inside of the unit.
2Exhaust fan motorDCFMCools the inside of the unit.
3Intake fan motorDCFM2Cools the inside of the unit.
4Fusing paper exit fanVFM2Cools the inside of the unit. (31 sheet model)
5Fusing paper exit fanVFM2Cools the inside of the unit.
6Ozon filter
7Ozon filter

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drive motor - 4
11.PWB

No.NameFunction and operation
1Inverter PWBCopy lamp control
2CCD PWBFor image scanning (read)
3Option connector PWB
4IMC PWBImage process
5MCU PWBMain unit control
6Mother boardConnection with FAX PWB
7Tray interface PWB2nd tray control
8DC power supply PWBDC voltage control
9High voltage PWBHigh voltage control
10KEY PWB
11OPU PWBOperation panel control
12SPLC PWBOutput image signal

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drive motor - 5
12. Roller

No.NameFunction and operation
1Paper exit rollerPaper exit roller
2Transport rollerPaper transport roller
3Upper heat rollerFuses toner on paper.(with the Teflon roller)
4Lower heat rollerFuses toner on paper.(with the silicone rubber roller)
5DUP transport follower rollerDuplex paper transport
6DUP transport rollerDuplex paper transport
7Transport rollerTransfer images on the drum onto paper.
8Resist rollerSynchronize the paper lead edge with the image lead edge.
9Manual paper feed rollerPicks up papers in manual paper feed port.
10Manual feed transport rollerTransports paper from the manual paper feed port.
111st tray pick-up rollerPicks up paper from the tray.
121st tray paper feed rollerTransports the picked up paper to RESIST section.
132nd tray pick-up rollerPicks up paper from the tray.
142nd tray paper feed rollerTransports the picked up paper to RESIST section.

[5] ADJUSTMENTS

1. Adjustment item list

SectionAdjustment itemAdjustment procedure/SIM No.
AProcess section(1)Developing doctor gap adjustmentDeveloping doctor gap adjustment
(2)MG roller main pole position adjustmentMG roller main pole position adjustment
(3)Developing bias voltage adjustmentSIM8-1
(4)Grid bias voltage adjustmentSIM8-2
BMechanism section(1)Print start position adjustmentSIM50-5
(2)RSPF image lead edge position adjustmentSIM50-6
(3)Rear edge void adjustmentSIM50-1
(4)Paper off center adjustmentSIM50-10
(5)Left edge void area adjustmentSIM50-1-8
(6)Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustmentNo. 2/3 mirror base unit installing position adjustment
Copy lamp unit installing position adjustment
(7)Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustmentWinding pulley position adjustment
(8)Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustmentRail height adjustment
(9)Main scanning direction (FR direction) magnification ratio adjustmentSIM48-1-1
(10)Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) magnification ratio adjustmentaOC mode in copying (SIM 48-1-2)
bRSPF sub scanning direction magnification ratio (SIM48-1-3, 48-1-4)
(11)Off center adjustment (RSPF mode)SIM50-12
(12)OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustmentSIM41-3
(13)Original sensor adjustmentSIM41-2, 41-4 (41-1)
(14)RSPF white correction pixel position adjustment (required in an RSPF model when replacing the lens unit)SIM63-7
(15)RSPF scan position auto adjustmentSIM53-8
CImage density (exposure) adjustment(1)Copy modeSIM46-2

2. Details of adjustment

A. Process section

(1) Developing doctor gap adjustment

1) Remove the doctor cover.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing doctor gap adjustment - 1

2) Loosen the developing doctor fixing screw A.
3) Insert a thickness gauge of 1.5mm to the positions of three screws on the developing doctor as shown.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing doctor gap adjustment - 2

4) Tighten the developing doctor fixing screw.
5) Check the clearance of the developing doctor. If it is within the specified range, then fix the doctor fixing screw with screw lock.
* When inserting a thickness gauge, be careful not to scratch the developing doctor and the MG roller.

Developing doctor gap

F/C/R:1.5+0.1mm

F/C/R:1.5 -0.15mm

(2) MG roller main pole position adjustment

1) Put the developing unit on a flat surface.
2) Tie a needle or pin on a string.
3) Hold the string and bring the needle close to the MG roller horizontally. (Do not use paper clip, which is too heavy to make a correct adjustment.) (Put the developing unit horizontally for this adjustment.)
4) Do not bring the needle into contact with the MG roller, but bring it to a position 2 or 3mm apart from the MG roller. Mark the point on the MG roller which is on the extension line from the needle tip.
5) Measure the distance from the marking position to the top of the doctor plate of the developing unit to insure that it is 9.1mm . If the distance is not within the specified range, loosen the fixing screw A of the main pole adjustment plate, and move the adjustment plate in the arrow direction to adjust.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - MG roller main pole position adjustment - 1

(3) Developing bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-1)

1) Execute SIM 8-1.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-1) - 1

2) Touch the exposure mode to be changed. The current set value is displayed.
3) Enter the set value with the 10-key.
4) Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AE (145)AE (145mm/s)200-650450
2TEXT (145)Character (145mm/s)450
3TEXT/PHOTO (145)Character/Photo (145mm/s)450
4PHOTO (145)Photo (145mm/s)450
5TONER SAVE (145)Toner save (145mm/s)400
6AE (122)AE (122mm/s)450
7TEXT (122)Character (122mm/s)450
8TEXT/PHOTO (122)Character/Photo (122mm/s)450
9PHOTO (122)Photo (122mm/s)450
10TONER SAVE (122)Toner save (122mm/s)400

Min. unit: -10V increment

(4) Grid bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-2)

1) Execute SIM 8-2.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Grid bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-2) - 1

2) Touch the exposure mode to be changed. The current set value is displayed.

3) Enter the set value with the 10-key.

4) Press the [START] key. Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AE (145)AE (145mm/s)350-750590
2TEXT (145)Character (145mm/s)590
3TEXT/PHOTO (145)Character/Photo (145mm/s)590
4PHOTO (145)Photo (145mm/s)590
5TONER SAVE (145)Toner save (145mm/s)540
6AE (122)AE (122mm/s)590
7TEXT (122)Character (122mm/s)590
8TEXT/PHOTO (122)Character/Photo (122mm/s)590
9PHOTO (122)Photo (122mm/s)590
10TONER SAVE (122)Toner save (122mm/s)540

Min. unit: -10V increment

B. Mechanism section

(1) Print start position adjustment

1) Execute SIM 50-5.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Print start position adjustment - 1

2) Touch the item to be adjusted. The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
3) Press the [P] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
4) Select the paper feed tray, the print density, and the duplex mode. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
5) Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1TRAY11st tray0-9953
2OPTIONOption tray1-99
3MANUALManual feed
4DUPLEXBack print

6) Measure the distance H between the paper lead edge and the image print start position. Set the image print start position set value again.

  • 1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
  • Calculate the set value from the formula below.

99 - H/0.127 (mm) = Image print start position set value

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Print start position adjustment - 2

  • Fit the print edge with the paper edge, and perform the lead edge adjustment.

Example: 99 - 5 / 0.127 = 99 - 39.4 = about 59

Note: If the set value is not obtained from the above formula, perform the fine adjustment.

7) Execute SIM 50-1-2 to adjust the main tray lead edge void.

  • 1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
  • Calculate the set value from the formula below.

B/0.127 (mm) = Lead edge void adjustment value

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Print start position adjustment - 3

Example: When setting the lead edge void to 2.5mm:

2.5/0.127 = about 20

Adjustment modeSIMSet valueSpec valueSetting range
Main tray lead edge void50-1B/0.127Lead edge void: 1 – 4mm1 – 99
-2
Print start position50-599 – H/0.127Image loss: 3mm or less

[H: Print start position measurement value (mm),

B: Lead edge void (mm)]

(2) RSPF image lead edge position adjustment

1) Set a scale on the OC table as shown below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - RSPF image lead edge position adjustment - 1

Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in paralleled with the edge lines.

2) Make a copy, then use the copy output as an original to make an RSPF copy again.
3) Check the copy output. If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
4) Execute SIM 50-6.
5) Set the RSPF lead edge position set value so that the same image is obtained as that obtained in the previous OC image lead edge position adjustment.

Adjustment modeSIMSet valueSpec valueSetting range
RSPF image lead edge position50-61 step: 0.127mm shiftLead edge void: 1 – 4mm Image loss: 3mm or less1 – 99

(3) Rear edge void adjustment

1) Set a scale as shown in the figure below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Rear edge void adjustment - 1

2) Set the document size to A4 (8.5" x 11"), and make a copy at 100% .
3) If an adjustment is required, follow the procedures below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Rear edge void adjustment - 2

4) Execute SIM 50-1 and set the density mode to DEN-B. The currently set adjustment value is displayed.
5) Enter the set value and press the start key.

The correction value is stored and a copy is made.

Adjustment modeSIMSet valueSpec valueSetting range
Rear edge void50-1-61 step: 0.127mm shift4mm or less1 – 99

(4) Paper off center adjustment

1) Set a test chart (UKOG-0089CSZZ) on the document table.
2) Select a paper feed port and make a copy.
3) Execute SIM 50-10.

SIMULATION 50-10 PRINT OFF-CENTER ADJUSTMENT. INPUT VALUE 1-99, AND PRESS START.
1: BYPASS5050
2: TRAY1501/1
3: TRAY250
4: TRAY350
5: TRAY450
6: DUPLEX50OK

4) Touch the item to be adjusted.

The item and the currently set value are highlighted.

5) Press the [START] key.

The display is shifted to the copy menu.

6) Select the paper feed tray and the print density.

Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.

7) Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1BYPASSManual paper feed1-9950
2TRAY11st tray
3TRAY22nd tray
4TRAY33rd tray
5TRAY44th tray
6DUPLEXBack print

Adjustment modeSIMSet valueSpec valueSetting range
Paper off center50-10 -2Add 1: 0.127mm shift to R side.Single: Center ±2.0mm1 – 99
Reduce 1: 0.127mm shift to L side.
Second print surface off-center50-10 -6Duplex: Center ±2.5mm

(5) Left edge void area adjustment

Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the paper off center adjustment (SIM 50-10) is completed.

1) Execute SIM 50-1.

SIMULATION 50-1 LEAD EDGE ADJUSTMENT. INPUT VALUE 1-99, AND PRESS START.
1: RRC-A432: DEN-A1843
3: DEN-A -MANUAL184: DEN-A -OPTION18
5: DEN-A -DUPLEX186: DEN-B31/1
7: DEN-B-DUP508: SIDE VOID181
9: SIDE VOID-DUP1810: LOSS(OC)3
OK

2) Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and change the value to 99.
3) Set SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) to 1. (By setting to 1, there is no void.)
4) Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC document table.
5) Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
6) Reset the adjustment values of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4) to the original values, and execute test print. Check the print out and adjust so that the lead edge image is printed on the lead edge of paper. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step).
7) Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the print out is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm /Step)
8) Similar to procedure 7, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
9) Similar to procedure 7, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 8, 9) so that the left edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
10) Make an enlargement copy (400%), and check that there is no shade of the cabinet printed at the lead edge.
11) If there is a shade printed at the lead edge in procedure 9, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 10). (1 - 5: About 0.677mm)

  • If there is no problem, set to 3.
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1RRC-AOriginal scan start position adjustment Lead edge position adjustment value (OC)1-9943
2DEN-ALead edge cancel adjustment (Main tray)1-9918
3DEN-A-MANUALLead edge cancel adjustment (Manual feed tray)1-9918
4DEN-A-OPTIONLead edge cancel adjustment (Option tray)1-9918
5DEN-A-DUPLEXLead edge cancel adjustment (back of the machine)1-9918
6DEN-BRear edge void adjustment1-9930
7DEN-B-DUPRear edge void adjustment (Duplex)1-9950
8SIDE VOIDLeft edge void adjustment (First print surface)1-9918
9SIDE VOID-DUPLeft edge void adjustment (Duplex)1-9918
10LOSS(OC)Image loss amount adjustment (Lead edge image loss set value) (OC)1-53

Adjustment modeSIMSet valueSpec valueSetting range
Left edge void50-11 step: 0.127mm shift0.5 – 4mm1 – 99
-8

(6) Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment

1) Remove the OC glass, the right cabinet and the upper right side cover.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 1

2) Loosen the copy lamp unit wire fixing screw.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 2

3) Manually turn the mirror base drive pulley and bring No. 2/3 mirror base unit into contact with the positioning plate.

At that time, if the front frame side and the rear frame side of No. 2/3 mirror base unit are brought into contact with the positioning plate at the same time, the mirror base unit parallelism is proper. If one of them is in contact with the positioning plate, perform the adjustment of 4).

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 3

4) Loosen the set screw of the scanner drive pulley which is not in contact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit positioning plate.

5) Without moving the scanner drive pulley shaft, manually turn the scanner drive pulley until the positioning plate is brought into contact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit, then fix the scanner drive pulley.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 4

6) Put No. 2/3 mirror base unit on the positioning plate again, push the projections on the front frame side and the rear frame side of the copy lamp unit to the corner frame, and tighten the wire fixing screw.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 5

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment - 6

(7) Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustment (Winding pulley position adjustment)

This adjustment must be performed in the following cases:

  • When the mirror base drive wire is replaced.
  • When the lamp unit, or No. 2/3 mirror holder is replaced.
  • When a copy as shown is made.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustment (Winding pulley position adjustment) - 1

1) Set A3 (11" x 17") white paper on the original table as shown below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustment (Winding pulley position adjustment) - 2

2) Open the original cover and make a normal (100%) copy.
3) Measure the width of the black background at the lead edge and at the rear edge.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustment (Winding pulley position adjustment) - 3

If the width (La) of the black background at the lead edge is equal that (Lb) at the rear edge, there is no need to execute the following procedures of 4) - 7).

4) Loosen the mirror base drive pulley fixing screw on the front frame side or on the rear frame side.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) distortion adjustment (Winding pulley position adjustment) - 4

5) Tighten the fixing screw of the mirror base drive pulley.

La = Lb

6) Execute the main scanning direction (FR) distortion balance adjustment previously described in 2) again.

(8) Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment)

When there is no skew copy in the mirror base scanning direction and there is no horizontal error (right angle to the scanning direction), the adjustment can be made by adjusting the No. 2/3 mirror base unit rail height.

Before performing this adjustment, be sure to perform the horizontal image distortion adjustment in the laser scanner section.

This adjustment must be performed in the following cases:

  • When the mirror base wire is replaced.
  • When the copy lamp unit and no. 2/3 mirror unit are replaced.
  • When the mirror unit rail is replaced and moved.
  • When a following copy is made.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 3

1) Make an original for the adjustment.

Make test sheet by drawing parallel lines at 10mm from the both ends of A3 (11'' × 17'') white paper as shown below. (These lines must be correctly parallel to each other.)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 4

2) Make a normal (100%) copy of the test sheet on A3 (11'' × 17'') paper. (Fit the paper edge and the glass holding plate edge.)
3) Measure the distances (La, Lb, Lc, Ld) at the four corners as shown below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 5

When La = Lb and Lc = Ld , no need to perform the procedures 4) and 5).

4) Move the mirror base B rail position up and down (in the arrow direction) to adjust.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment) - 6

  • When La > Lb
  • Shift the mirror base B rail upward by the half of the difference of La-Lb.
  • When La < Lb Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference of Lb-La. Example: When La = 12mm and Lb = 9mm, shift the mirror base B rail upward by 1.5mm.
  • When Lc >Ld Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference of Lc-Ld.
  • When Lc < Ld
  • When Lc < Ld, move the mirror base B on the paper feed side upward.
  • When moving the mirror base rail, hold the mirror base rail with your hand.

La = Lb, Lc = Ld

5) After completion of adjustment, manually turn the mirror base drive pulley, scan the mirror base A and mirror base B fully, and check that the mirror bases are not in contact with each other.
* If the mirror base rail is moved extremely, the mirror base may be in contact with the frame or the original glass. Be careful to avoid this.

(9) Main scanning direction (FR direction) magnification ratio adjustment (SIM 48-1)

Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the CCD unit is properly installed.

1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Main scanning direction (FR direction) magnification ratio adjustment (SIM 48-1) - 1

2) Execute SIM 48-1.
3) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of the main scanning direction magnification ratio is displayed on the display section in 2 digits.
4) Manual correction mode (SIM48-1-1)

Enter the set value and press the start key.

The correction value is stored and a copy is made.

Note: A judgment must be made with 200mm width, and must not be made with 100mm width.

Adjustment modeSpec valueSIMSet valueSetting range
Main scanning direction magnification ratioAt normal: ±1.0%48-1-1Add 1: 0.1% increase Reduce 1: 0.1% decrease1 – 99

(10) Sub scanning direction (scanning direction) magnification ratio adjustment (SIM 48-1-2, SIM 48-1-3)

a. OC mode in copying

Note: Execute the procedure after completion of SIM 48-1-1.

1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below, and make a normal (100%) copy.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - a. OC mode in copying - 1

2) Compare the scale image and the actual scale. If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
3) Execute SIM 48-1-2.
4) Enter the set value and press the start key. The set value is stored and a copy is made.

Adjustment modeSpec valueSIMSet valueSetting range
Sub scanning direction magnification ratio (OC mode)At normal: ±1.0%48-1-2Add 1: 0.05% increase Reduce 1: 0.05% decrease1 – 99

b. RSPF mode in copying

Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the CCD unit is properly installed and that OC mode adjustment in copying has been completed.

1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below, and make a normal (100%) copy to make a test chart.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - b. RSPF mode in copying - 1

Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in parallel with the front side edge of the glass.

2) Set the test chart on the RSPF and make a normal (100%) copy.
3) Compare the scale image and the actual image. If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
4) Execute SIM 48-1-3.
5) After warm-up, shading is performed. The current front surface sub scanning direction magnification ratio correction value is displayed in two digits on the display section.

6) Enter the set value and press the start key. The set value is stored and a copy is made.
7) Execute SIM 48-1-4. The current back surface sub scanning direction magnification ratio is displayed in two digits on the display section.
8) Enter the set value and press the start key. The set value is stored and a copy is made.

Adjustment modeSpec valueSIMSet valueSetting range
Sub scanning direction magnification ratio (RSPF mode)At normal: ±1.0%48-1-3 48-1-4Add 1: 0.05% increase Reduce 1: 0.05% decrease1 – 99

(11) Off center adjustment (RSPF mode)

Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the paper off center is properly adjusted.

1) Place the center position adjustment test chart (sheet with a straight line in the scan direction at the center) on the RSPF.
2) Make a normal copy from the manual paper feed tray, and check the printed copy with the test chart. If any adjustment is required, perform the following procedure.

3) Execute SIM 50-12.
4) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of the off center adjustment is displayed on the display section in 2 digits.
5) Enter the set value and press the start key. The set value is stored and a copy is made.

Adjustment modeSpec valueSIMSet valueSetting range
Original off center mode (RSPF mode)Single: Center ± 3.0mm50-12Add 1: 0.1mm shift to R side1 – 99
Duplex: Center ±3.5mmReduce 1: 0.1mm shift to L side

(12) OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustment

1) Execute SIM 41-3.
2) Gradually close the OC (RSPF) from the full open position, and measure distance A when the display on the operation panel changes. (See the figure below.)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustment - 1
Distance A = Table glass top - OC (RSPF) handle rib

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustment - 2

OC (SPF) open/close position A: 125 - 225mm

3) If the distance is outside the specified range, adjust the open/close sensor attachment plate position as shown below.

  • Distance < 125 mm : Shift toward A.
  • Distance > 225 mm : Shift toward B.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustment - 1

(13) Original sensor adjustment (SIM 41-2, 41-4)

1) Set A3 (11'' × 17'') paper on the OC table. (Keep the SPF (OC cover) open.)
2) Execute SIM 41-2.
3) Keep A=125mm, and execute SIM 41-4. (Do not put paper on the table.)
4) Check the reaction with SIM 41-1.

(14) RSPF white correction pixel position adjustment (required in an RSPF model when replacing the lens unit) (SIM63-7)

1) Fully open the RSPF.
2) Execute SIM 63-7.
3) When the operation panel displays "COMPLETE," the adjustment is completed.
4) If the operation panel displays "ERROR," perform the following measures.

  • When the display is 0: Check that the SPF is open.

Check that the lamp is ON. (If the lamp is OFF, check the MCU connector.)

Check that the CCD harness is properly inserted into the MCU connector.

  • When the display is 281 or above:

1) Remove the table glass.
2) Remove the dark box.
3) Slide the lens unit toward the front side and attach it, then execute SIM.

  • When the display is 143 or below:

1) Remove the table glass.
2) Remove the dark box.
3) Slide the lens unit toward the rear side and attach it, then execute SIM.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - RSPF white correction pixel position adjustment (required in an RSPF model when replacing the lens unit) (SIM63-7) - 1

  • When the lens unit is moved, execute the OC main scanning magnification ratio auto adjustment, SIM 48-1-1.
  • This adjustment is basically O.K. with SIM 63-7.

(15) RSPF scan position auto adjustment

[Function]

Used to adjust the RSPF scan position automatically.

[Operation]

1) With the RSPF or the OC cover open, place a white paper background on the OC glass. (In the RSPF standard model, the RSPF glass surface is included.)
2) Enter SIM53-08, and press [START] button. Outline of SIM: The optical unit is shifted to recognize the boundary between the OC glass and the RSPF glass cover. With the same position as the reference, the RSPF scan position is automatically adjusted.

  • After completion of the RSPF scan position auto adjustment, the RSPF lead edge adjustment must be executed. (Both surfaces)
  • There must be no other sheet than the black chart on the glass surface.
  • Especially when in RSPF scan, the center area is scanned in the main scan direction. Be careful to prevent external light from entering the scan area.
    3) Check that the lead edge is not shifted. (Both surfaces) (If the original lead edge adjustment has been made properly, even when the scan position is shifted, it is followed automatically.)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - [Operation] - 1

C. Image density (exposure) adjustment

(1) Copy mode (SIM46-2)

1) Set a test chart (UKOG-0162FCZZ) on the OC table as shown below.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Copy mode (SIM46-2) - 1

2) Place three or more sheets of A3 (11" x 17") paper on the test chart.
3) Execute SIM 46-2.
4) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of the density (exposure) level is displayed on the display section in 2 digits.

For mode selection, use the [10-key].

5) Change the set value with the [10-key] to adjust the copy image density.
6) Make a copy and check that the specification below is satisfied.

Note: Place originals in the rear reference, and the test chart in the front reference when adjusting the exposure.

Density modeExposure levelSharp Gray Chart outputSet valueSetting range
AUTO-"3" is copied.If too bright, increase the quantity displayed on the copy quantity display.1 - 99
TEXT3.0"3" is copied.
TEXT/PHOTO3.0"3" is copied.
PHOTO3.0"2" is copied.
AE (TONER SAVE)-"3" is copied.If too dark, decrease the quantity displayed on the copy quantity display.
TEXT (TONER SAVE)3.0"3" is copied.
TEXT PHOTO (TONER SAVE)3.0"3" is copied.

[6] SIMULATION

1. General

A. Outline and purpose

The simulation has the following functions to grasp the machine operating status, identify the trouble position and causes in an earlier stage, and make various setups and adjustments speedily for improving the serviceability of the machine.

1) Various adjustments
2) Setup of specifications and functions
3) Canceling troubles
4) Operation check
5) Various counters check, setup, and clear
6) Machine operating status (operation history) data check, clear
7) Transfer of various data (adjustments, setup, operations, counters)

The operating procedures and the displays differ depending on the form of the operation panel of the machine.

B. Code-type simulation

(1) Operating procedures and operations

  • Entering the simulation mode
    1) #/P key (program) ON Asterisk (*) key ON CLEAR key ON Asterisk (*) key ON Ready for input of a main code of simulation
    2) Entering a main code with the 10-key START key ON
    3) Entering a sub code with the 10-key START key ON
    4) Select an item with the scroll key and the item key.
    5) The machine enters the mode corresponding to the selected item. Press START key to start the simulation operation.

To cancel the current simulation mode or to change the main code and the sub code, press the SYSTEM SETTINGS key.

  • Canceling the simulation mode to return to the normal mode

1) Press CLEAR ALL key.

(2) How to change the simulation adjustment value set by the touch panel in the adjustment value entry process

a. Target SIM list

3-7, 8-1, 8-2, 8-3, 8-10, 8-11, 8-12, 9-5, 43-1, 44-34, 46-2, 46-9, 46-10, 46-11, 46-18, 46-20, 46-30, 46-31, 48-1, 48-2, 50-1, 50-5, 50-6, 50-10, 50-12, 51-1, 51-2, 51-9, 53-7

b. Touch panel operating procedure

  • In the adjustment value setup menu, the selected item is highlighted. Change is made to the highlighted simulation adjustment value.
  • If all the list of the adjustment items is not shown on one page, touch [↑] and [↓] button to shift the page.
  • To change an adjustment value, touch the select the item to change the adjustment value. (The selected item is highlighted.) Enter the adjustment value and perform one of the following procedures, and the display of the adjustment value of the selected item is renewed as well as the adjustment value.

1) Touch [OK] button.
2) Touch another selected item to change the selection state.
3) If all the list of the adjustment items cover two or more pages, touch [] and [] button to shift the page.
4) Press [START] key.
* For simulations which allow confirmation print, copying is started after changing the adjustment value.

(46-2, 46-9, 46-10, 46-11, 46-18, 48-1, 48-2, 50-1, 50-5, 50-6, 50-10, 50-12, 51-2, the bold-faced items in the above list.)

  • If the entry value is outside the adjustable range, an error buzzer sounds and the adjustment value is not renewed. Page shift is not made, either.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - b. Touch panel operating procedure - 1

  1. Simulation code list
CodeFunction
MainSub
11Used to check the operation of the scanner unit and its control circuit.
2Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the scanning (read) section and the related circuit.
21Used to check the operation of the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
2Used to check the operation of sensors and detectors in the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
3Used to check the operation of the loads in the RSPF unit and the control circuits.
32Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the finisher and the related circuit.
3Used to check the operation of the load in the finisher and the control circuit.
10Used to make each adjustment of the finisher.
11Used to check the shifter operation. Reciprocating operations are continuously performed or the home position is checked. (The shifter is shifted to the home position or moved in one way by the specified steps.)
42Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the option tray and the related circuit.
3Used to check the operation of the load in the option tray and the control circuit.
51Used to check the operation of the display (LED), LCD in the operation panel, and control circuit.
2Used to check the operation of the heater lamp and the control circuit.
3Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and the control circuit.
61Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches and solenoids) in the paper transport system and the control circuit.
2Used to check the operation of each fan motor and its control circuit.
71Used to set the aging operation conditions.
6Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging.
8Used to set the display of the warm-up time.
81Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in each copy mode and the control circuit.
2Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in each copy mode and the control circuit.
10Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in each printer mode and the control circuit.
11Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in each printer mode and the control circuit.
13Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the control circuit.
14Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in FAX mode and the control circuit.
91Used to check and adjust the operation of the load (motor) in the duplex section and the control circuit.
4Duplex motor RPM setting
5Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation to normal rotation of the duplex motor.
100Used to check the operation of the toner motor and its control circuit.
CodeFunction
MainSub
140Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF troubles.
160Used to cancel the self-diag U2 trouble.
170Used to cancel the self diag “PF” trouble.
211Used to set the maintenance cycle.
221Used to check the counter value of each section.
2Used to check the total numbers of misfeed and troubles. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it is judged as necessary for repair. The misfeed rate is obtained by dividing this count value with the total counter value.)
3Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of misfeed at each position. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
4Used to check the total trouble (self diag) history.
5Used to check the ROM version of each unit (section).
6Used to print each system setting, the account information, and the machine adjustment values.
7Used to display of the administrator password.
8Used to display the original, staple counter.
9Used to check the number of use of each paper feed section. (the number of prints)
10Used to check the system configuration.
11Used to display the FAX send/receive counter (FAX reception and print counter).
12Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of misfeed at each position. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
13Used to display the CRUM type.
19Used to display the scanner counter in the network scanner mode.
241Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed history, the trouble counter, and the trouble history. (The counters are cleared after completion of maintenance.)
2Used to clear the number of use (the number of prints) of each paper feed section.
3Used to clear the number usage data of the stapler, RSPF, and scanning.
4Used to reset the maintenance counter.
5Used to reset the developer counter. (The developer counter of the DV unit which is installed is reset.)
6Used to clear the copy counter.
7Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane decrease) correction counter. (This simulation is executed when the OPC drum is replaced.)
9Used to clear the printer counter and other counters.
10FAX counter data clear
15Used to clear the scanner counter in the network scanner mode.
251Used to check the operation of the main drive (excluding the scanner section) and to check the operation of the toner concentration sensor. (The toner concentration sensor output can be monitored.)
2Used to make the initial setting of toner concentration when replacing developer.
261Used to set whether the job separator is installed or not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware detection, it is set in this simulation.)
262Used to set whether the automatic detection of paper size is made or not.
3Used to set the specifications of the auditor. Setting must be made depending on the use condition of the auditor.
5Used to set the count mode of the total counter and the maintenance counter.
6Used to set the specifications depending on the destination.
12Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC.
14Used to input the Software Key for the PS extension kit.
18Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation.
22Used to set the specification (language display) for the destination.
30Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up control conforming to the CE mark control.
35Used to set whether the same continuous troubles are displayed as one trouble or the series of troubles with SIM 22-4 when the same troubles occur continuously.
36Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the maintenance counter life is expired.
37Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the developer counter life is expired.
38Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the drum counter life is expired.
50Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white reversion function.
56Gamma life correction setting
57Used to set the model code.
60Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key when FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed, the FAX mode is enabled regardless of this setup.)
71In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (pre-heat mode setting) and the auto power shut off time can be set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1 min, auto power shut off: 1 min) and the long time setup (pre-heat: 15min, auto power shut off: 60min).
72The letterhead support is set. When "Letterhead paper setting" is selected, the set value of SIM 26-46 (Image output direction setting) is set to "Setting Enable" accordingly.
301Used to display the sensor status attached to the machine.
2Used to display the status of the sensors attached to the standard tray and the manual feed tray. (Use SIM 4-2 for the option trays.) The sensor of an uninstalled tray is not displayed.
401Used to check the sensor of the machine manual feed tray.
2Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper width detector detection level.
3The AD conversion value of manual feed width detection is displayed.
411Used to check the document size detection photo sensor.
2Used to adjust the detection level of the document size photo sensor.
3Used to check the light reception level and the detection level of the original size detection photo sensor.
4Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20 degrees.
CodeFunction
MainSub
431Used to set the fusing temperature.
10Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when printing postcards.
441Used to make various setups in each mode of process control.
2Drum life correction setting
3Used to set the DV count correction.
9Used to display the process control correction information.
14Used to display the environment (temperature, humidity) correction information.
16Used to set the toner density control correction value.
17Used to display the toner density control reference value.
34Used to set the transfer current value in each mode.
40Used to set the time from the start of the main motor rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply in previous rotation after turning on the power.
462Used to set the exposure level in each exposure mode.
9Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Text).
10Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Text/Photo).
11Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Photo).
12FAX exposure level adjustment (1 mode automatic adjustment)
13FAX exposure level adjustment (Normal mode individual adjustment)
14FAX exposure level adjustment (Fine text mode individual adjustment)
15FAX exposure level adjustment (Super Fine mode individual adjustment)
16FAX exposure level adjustment (Ultra Fine mode individual adjustment)
18Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
19Used to set the control method of the exposure mode.
20Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/RSPF for OC exposure.
30Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner save).
31Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner save).
39Used to switch the FAX send image quality.
481Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio (main scanning direction, sub scanning direction).
2Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification ratio (main/sub scanning direction).
3Used to adjust the print mode magnification ratio correction.
8FAX magnification adjustment (read)
9FAX magnification adjustment (print)
501Used to adjust the copy lead edge position.
5Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on the print paper in the print mode.
6Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on print paper in the copy mode. (RSPF)
8FAX lead edge adjustment (read)
9FAX lead edge adjustment (print)
5010Used to adjust the print image center position.(Adjustment can be made for each paper feed section.)
12Used to adjust the print image center position.(Adjustment can be made for each document mode.)
511Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON time.
2Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto the resist roller in each section (copier paper feed section, duplex paper feed section, RSPF paper feed section). (When the print image position varies greatly for the paper or when a lot of paper jam troubles occur, the adjustment is required.)
8Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl operation inhibit. (ON/OFF)
9Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage ON/OFF timing.
536Used to adjust the detection level of the RSPF width. The adjustment method is the 4-point system. Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position, and Min. position for adjustment.
7Used to enter the RSPF width detection adjustment value.
8Used to adjust the RSPF scan position of the mirror unit automatically. For the RSPF scan position automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is shifted to 11mm before the RSPF glass cover edge, and is operated automatically to scan images by the unit of 1 step, detecting the position up to the glass cover automatically.
9RSPF read position adjustment
10RSPF exp adjustment
551Used to set the soft switch.
611Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation. Check speed can select 145mm/s or 122mm/s individually.
631Used to check the result of shading correction. (The shading correction data are displayed.)
7Used to adjust the RSPF white correction start pixel position automatically. This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is replaced.
641Used to check the operation of the printer function (auto print operation).
651Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display section) detection position.
2Used to check the touch panel (LCD display section) detection position adjustment result.
5Used to check the key inputs of the operation panel.
661Used to change and check the FAX-related soft SW.
2Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW. (Except for the FAX adjustment values)
3FAX PWB memory check
4Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
5Signal send mode (Signal send level soft SW setting)
6Printing the confidential password
7Print the screen memory contents
10Image data memory clear
11Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level: Max.)
12Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level: Set by soft SW)
13Used to register the dial numbers.
14Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
15Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
16Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send test)
CodeFunction
MainSub
6617Used to check the DTFM signal send operation. (Signal send level: Max.)
18Used to check the DTFM signal send operation. (Signal send level: Set by soft SW.)
19Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
20Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM.
21FAX information print
22Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
24Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
30Used to set the TEL/LIU.
31Used to set the TEL/LIU.
32Receive data check
33Signal detection check
34Communication time measurement display
37Speaker sound volume adjustment
41CI signal check
52Pseudo-ringer check

3. Details of simulation

1

1-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the scanner unit and its control circuit.
SectionOptical (Image scanning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the original size.

  1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The scanner unit operates at the speed corresponding to the set value.

The scan counter is displayed during execution.

Set magnification ratio25% to 400% (1% increment) (Default 100%)
Document sizeVaries depending on the destination.
Set number of times1 to 999 (0: Continuous operation)

1-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the scanning (read) section and the related circuit.
SectionOptical (Image scanning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The status of sensors and detectors in the scanner section is displayed. The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

MHPS Mirror home position sensor

2

2-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
SectionRSPF
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the original size.

  1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The RSPF unit operates at the speed corresponding to the set value.

The scan counter is displayed during execution.

Set magnification ratio50% to 200% (1% increment) (Default 100%)
Document sizeVaries depending on the destination.
DuplexSelectable only when RSPF is installed.
Set number of times1 to 999 (0: Continuous operation)

Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.

2-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of sensors and detectors in the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
SectionRSPF
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The operations of sensors and detectors in the RSPF section are displayed.

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

(For the original size, the detection result of the original size displayed on the copy menu is highlighted.)

EMPSOriginal empty sensor
DLS1Original length sensor (Small)
DLS2Original length sensor (Large)
FGODRSPF paper feed cover open/close sensor
DFDRSPF paper entry sensor
RDDRSPF original exit sensor
OPCLSBook sensor
SWD_LENOriginal detection width sensor (Unit of 0.1mm. "Width x 10" is displayed. Example: For 300mm, 3000 is displayed.)
SWD_A/DOriginal detection width sensor A/D value

RSPF width detection size (One of the following is displayed.)

A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, EXTRA, 8K/16K, 16KR

Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.

2-3

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the loads in the RSPF unit and the control circuits.
SectionRSPF
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec. (20 times)

ItemContent
1DTM-FRSPF motor forward rotation
2DTM-RRSPF motor reverse rotation
3DFCLRSPF paper feed clutch
4CLHRSPF PS clutch
5GSOLDocument exit gate solenoid
6RSOLDocument exit pressure solenoid

Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.

3-2
PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the finisher and the related circuit.
SectionFinisher
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Used to display the operations of sensors and detectors in the finisher section.

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

FDTPDPaper delivery tray paper detector
FSTPDStaple tray paper detector
FAPHPS-RPaper alignment plate HP sensor R
FAPHPS-FPaper alignment plate HP sensor F
FDRPSDelivery roller position sensor
FPPD1Paper pass detector
FDTLLSDelivery tray lower limit sensor
FTPSTray position sensor
FPLDPaper level detector
FSSWSafety switch
FSLDStaple lead edge detector
FSEDStaple empty detector
FSHPSStaple HP sensor
FPRDProcess tray paper rear edge detection
FPLSPaper level sensor

Note: Executable only when the finisher is installed.

3-3
PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the load in the finisher and the control circuit.
SectionFinisher
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The finisher main motor operates for 10sec, the staple motor 5 times, the tray lift-up motor one reciprocating operation, other motors max. 20 reciprocating operations from the home position, the solenoid repeats 500msec ON and 500msec OFF 20 times.

The staple operation motor operates only when there is no cartridge installed.

ItemContent
1FTLMTray lift motor
2FSMStaple motor
3FPAM-RPaper alignment motor R
4FPAM-FPaper alignment motor F
5FPDMPaper delivery motor
6FPSPaddle solenoid
7FPTMPaper transport motor
8FDRLMDelivery roller lift motor
9FPGSPaper gate solenoid
10FARLSAlignment roller lift solenoid
11FSLStaple light
3-10
PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to make each adjustment of the finisher.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select an item to be adjusted with 10-key, and press [START] key.
  2. Enter an adjustment value with 10-key, and press [START] key.
ItemContentInstallation rangeDefault
1FPAM ADJUSTPaper alignment width adjustment40-6050
2FDRLM ADJUSTPaper delivery roller descending position adjustment40-6050
3-11
PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the shifter operation.Reciprocating operations are continuously performed or the home position is checked.(The shifter is shifted to the home position or moved in one way by the specified steps.)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select item "1," and press the [START] key.

The shifter is reciprocated continuously at the specified interval.

ItemContent
1F-RReciprocating operation
2HP CHECKHome position check

[Selection 2]

  1. Select item "2," and press the [START] key.
  2. Move the shifter to the home position or in one way by the specified steps with the following keys.
[*] keyShifts the position toward R side by the specified steps.
[0 keyShifts the position toward HP side by the specified steps.
[#] keyShifts to F.
SFTHPShifter home position (At detection, highlighted)

4-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in the option tray and the related circuit.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The operating states of the sensor and the detector are displayed. (Only the installed option trays are displayed. For the standard tray, use SIM 30-2.)

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

PED22nd tray paper empty sensor
LUD22nd tray paper upper limit detection sensor
PFD22nd tray paper pass sensor
CD22nd tray empty sensor
PED33rd tray paper empty sensor
LUD33rd tray paper upper limit detection sensor
PFD33rd tray paper pass sensor
CD33rd tray empty sensor
PED44th tray paper empty sensor
LUD44th tray paper upper limit detection sensor
PFD44th tray paper pass sensor
CD44th tray empty sensor
DSWR22nd tray right door detection sensor
DSWR33rd tray right door detection sensor
DSWR44th tray right door detection sensor

Note: Execution is possible only when the option tray is installed.

4-3

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the load in the option tray and the control circuit.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.

The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened. (20 times)

ItemContent
1LUM22nd tray lift-up motor
2CPFC22nd tray pick-up solenoid
3CPFS22nd tray paper feed clutch
4TRC22nd tray transport roller clutch
5DM2nd tray paper transport motor (3rd tray paper transport motor)
6LUM33rd tray lift-up motor
7CPFC33rd tray pick-up solenoid
8CPFS33rd tray paper feed clutch
9TRC33rd tray transport roller clutch
10LUM44th tray lift-up motor
11CPFC44th tray pick-up solenoid
12CPFS44th tray paper feed clutch

Note: Execution is possible only when the option tray is installed.

5-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the display (LED), LCD in the operation panel, and control circuit.
SectionOperation (screen/operation)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The LCD is displayed as follows. (All LED's are ON.)

With the upper half highlighted and the lower half normally displayed, contrast changes "Standard MAX MIN." in every 2sec.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Operation/procedure - 1

(6 sec later)

With the upper half normally displayed and the lower half highlighted, contrast changes "Standard MAX MIN." in every 2sec.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Operation/procedure - 2

  • When returning to the sub menu selection menu, the display of the standard contrast is displayed for an instant.

5-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the heater lamp and the control circuit.
SectionFusing
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the lamp to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

ON/OFF operation of the heater lamp is repeated 5 times in an interval of 100ms/900ms.

When completing the operation, the cooling fan is rotated at a low speed.

Item Content

ItemContent
1HL1Heater lamp 1 (Main) operation
2HL2Heater lamp 2 (Sub) operation

5-3

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and the control circuit.
SectionOptical (Image scanning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

When the [START] key is pressed, the copy lamp is lighted for 10sec.

6-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches and solenoids) in the paper transport system and the control circuit.
SectionPaper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec. (20 times)

When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] is pressed, the operation is interrupted.

The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened.

ItemContent
1LUM11st tray lift-up motor
2CPFC11st tray pick-up solenoid
3CPFS11st tray paper feed clutch
4MPFSManual feed pick-up solenoid
5RRCResist roller clutch
6PSPSSeparation pawl solenoid
7OGSPaper exit gate switching solenoid
8LUM22nd tray lift-up motor
9CPFC22nd tray pick-up solenoid
10CPFS22nd tray paper feed clutch
11TRC22nd tray transport roller clutch
12LUM33rd tray lift-up motor
13CPFC33rd tray pick-up solenoid
14CPFS33rd tray paper feed clutch
15TRC33rd tray transport roller clutch
16LUM44th tray lift-up motor
17CPFC44th tray pick-up solenoid
18CPFS44th tray paper feed clutch
19ROGSRight paper exit gate solenoid

The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened.

6-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of each fan motor and its control circuit.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

The selected load is operated for 10sec.

ItemContent
1VFMFusing fan operates
2DCFM&DCFM2Power cooling fan, power cooling fan 2 operations
3VFM2Fusing exit paper fan operates
3VFM&DCFM&DCFM2 &VFM2Fusing fan, power cooling fan, and power cooling fan 2 are operated at the same time.

7-1

PurposeSetting/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to set the aging operation conditions.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the load to be set with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

When selected without setup, the selected value is registered and highlighted. When selected with previous setup, the previous setup is canceled and it is displayed normally.

Press [CA] key, and the simulation will be terminated and the machine goes into the aging standby mode with the set content.

This setting is canceled by power OFF.

ItemContent
1AGINGAging enable/disable setting
2MISFEEDJam detection enable/disable setting
3FUSING*1Fusing operation enable/disable setting The fusing temperature is not controlled. The heater is not turned ON.
4INTERVLIntermittent setting (Valid only when set to AGING.)
5WARMUPWarm-up save setting The machine goes into the ready state only by shading, disregarding fusing and process control. After going into the ready state, normal control is performed.
6DV CHK.Developing unit detection enable/disable setting

*1: When the machine exits from the fusing ignoring state, the roller may be cooled down. Therefore, reset the machine to warm up again.

When, therefore, the simulation is canceled by pressing the [CA] key or when the copy mode display is shifted to the initial menu display in the simulation mode of one page copy, the machine is reset.

Note: In SIM 7-1, pressing [CA] key terminates the simulation and the machine enters the aging mode without resetting. Therefore, to perform "4. Intermittent setup," the intermittent cycle must be set with SIM 7-6 in advance.

Reset is not performed when the machine enters the aging mode.

7-6

PurposeSetting/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the interval aging cycle time (sec) with the 10-key pad. Refer to SIM 7-1.
  2. Press the [START] key.

When the [START] key is pressed in aging, copying is performed continuously. This simulation is used to set the time interval between copy operations in the unit of second.

This setting is valid when SIM 7-1 (Intermittent setting) is enabled.

Setting range1-255
Default3

7-8

PurposeSetting/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to set the display of the warm-up time.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Warm-up starts by the cover open/close.

(Can be performed repeatedly by open/close of the cover.)

  1. The warm-up time is counted up and displayed in the unit of sec.
    If the [CA] key is pressed at this time, count-up is interrupted to terminate the simulation. (However, warm-up is continued.)
  2. After completion of warming up, "WARM UP COMPLETED" is displayed and the control returns to the initial screen.

8

8-1

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in each copy mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
    The current set value is displayed.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AE (145)AE (145mm/s)200-650450
2TEXT (145)Character (145mm/s)450
3TEXT/PHOTO (145)Character/Photo (145mm/s)450
4PHOTO (145)Photo (145mm/s)450
5TONER SAVE (145)Toner save (145mm/s)400
6AE (122)AE (122mm/s)450
7TEXT (122)Character (122mm/s)450
8TEXT/PHOTO (122)Character/Photo (122mm/s)450
9PHOTO (122)Photo (122mm/s)450
10TONER SAVE (122)Toner save (122mm/s)400

(*) Linked with the destinations of SIM 26-6.

Linked with the auto exposure mode of SIM 46-19-1.

The minimum increment is 10V.

The result of (Set value) -200/ 10 is stored in the EEPROM.

When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value

*10+200) is used as the set value.

8-2

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in each copy mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Photo conductor

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
    The current set value is displayed.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AE (145)AE (145mm/s)350-750590
2TEXT (145)Character (145mm/s)590
3TEXT/PHOTO (145)Character/Photo (145mm/s)590
4PHOTO (145)Photo (145mm/s)590
5TONER SAVE (145)Toner save (145mm/s)540
6AE (122)AE (122mm/s)590
7TEXT (122)Character (122mm/s)590
8TEXT/PHOTO (122)Character/Photo (122mm/s)590
9PHOTO (122)Photo (122mm/s)590
10TONER SAVE (122)Toner save (122mm/s)540

Min. unit: 10V increment

(*) Linked with the destinations of SIM 26-6.

Linked with the auto exposure mode of SIM 46-19-1.

8-10

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in each printer mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
    The current set value is displayed.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentInstallation rangeDefault
1DENS1 (145)Density1 (145mm/s)200-650300
2DENS2 (145)Density2 (145mm/s)370
3DENS3 (145)Density3 (145mm/s)420
4DENS4 (145)Density4 (145mm/s)530
5DENS5 (145)Density5 (145mm/s)600
6TS (145)Toner save (145mm/s)250
7DENS1 (122)Density1 (122mm/s)300
8DENS2 (122)Density2 (122mm/s)370
9DENS3 (122)Density3 (122mm/s)420
10DENS4 (122)Density4 (122mm/s)530
11DENS5 (122)Density5 (122mm/s)600
12TS (122)Toner save (122mm/s)250

The minimum increment is 10V.

The result of (Set value) -200/ 10 is stored in the EEPROM.

When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value *10+200) is used as the set value.

8-11

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in each printer mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Photo conductor

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.

The current set value is highlighted.

  1. Enter the set value with

  2. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContentInstalla- tion rangeDefault
1DENS1 (145)Density 1 (145mm/s)350-750440
2DENS2 (145)Density 2 (145mm/s)510
3DENS3 (145)Density 3 (145mm/s)560
4DENS4 (145)Density 4 (145mm/s)670
5DENS5 (145)Density 5 (145mm/s)740
6TS (145)Toner save (145mm/s)390
7DENS1 (122)Density 1 (122mm/s)440
8DENS2 (122)Density 2 (122mm/s)510
9DENS3 (122)Density 3 (122mm/s)560
10DENS4 (122)Density 4 (122mm/s)670
11DENS5 (122)Density 5 (122mm/s)740
12TS (122)Toner save (122mm/s)390

Min. unit: 10V increment

8-13

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display returns to the original state.

Setting range200-650
Default450

The minimum increment is 10V.

The result of (Set value-200) / 10 is stored in the EEPROM.

When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value * 10 +200) is used as the set value.

Therefore, an even number must be entered. If not, the entered odd number +1 is displayed after pressing [START] key.

8-14

PurposeAdjustment/Operation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the main charger grid voltage in FAX mode and the control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Photo conductor

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display returns to the original state.

Setting range350-750
Default590

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Operation/procedure - 1

9-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check and adjust the operation of the load (motor) in the duplex section and the control circuit.
SectionDuplex
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the operation mode with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

The operation is performed for 30sec, and the display returns to the original state.

ItemContent
1DMF145Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation (145mm/s)
2DMF122Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation (122mm/s)
3DMR145Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation (145mm/s)
4DMR122Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation (122mm/s)

9-4

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Duplex motor RPM setting
SectionDuplex
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the set value with the 10-key.

When the duplex motor setting is made, the duplex 2motor is also set accordingly.

Setting range1-13
Default5

9-5

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation to normal rotation of the duplex motor.

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to set.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
ItemInstallation rangeDefault
1145mm/s18-7618
2122mm/s18
3RIGHT 145mm/s50
4RIGHT 122mm/s50

10

10-0

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the toner motor and its control circuit.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Press the [START] key and operate the toner motor for 30 sec.

14

14-0

PurposeClear/Cancel (Trouble etc.)
Function (Purpose)Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF troubles.
ItemTroubleError

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.
  2. When "1: YES" is selected, troubles other than U2 and PF are canceled. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

16

16-0

PurposeClear/Cancel (Trouble etc.)
Function (Purpose)Used to cancel the self-diag U2 trouble.
ItemTroubleError

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.
  2. When "1: YES" is selected, U2 trouble is canceled. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

17

17-0

PurposeCancel (Trouble, etc)
Function (Purpose)Used to cancel the self diag “PF” trouble.
ItemTroubleError

Operation/Procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.
  2. When “1: YES” is selected, PF trouble is canceled. (When “2: NO” is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

21

21-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the maintenance cycle.
ItemSpecificationsCounter

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.
ItemContent
26cpm31cpm
05K5K
110K10K
220K50K
325K75K
450K100K
575K (Default)150K (Default) *
6FREEFREE
  • When selecting 150K, maintenance message is displayed by implementing the following conditions.
  • Maintenance count = 150K.
  • DV count = 100K
  • DR count = 100K
  • When maintenance message is displayed, replace consumption part reaching the number of sheets of maintenance, then clear the replaced part's counter only.

22-1

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the counter value of each section.
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Each counter is displayed.

TOTALTotal counter
MAINTENANCEMaintenance counter
DEVEDeveloper counter
DRUMDrum counter
COPYCopy counter
PRINTERPrinter counter
IMCIMC counter
DUPLEXDuplex counter
OTHERSThe other counters
FAX SENDFAX Send counter
FAX RCVFAX receive counter
FAX OUTPUTFAX print counter
DEVE RANGEDeveloper traveling distance counter
DRUM RANGEDrum traveling distance counter
DEVE ROLLDeveloper rotation counter (K)
DRUM ROLLDrum rotation counter (K)
DEVE LIFEDeveloper life meter (%)
DRUM LIFEDrum life meter (%)

22-2

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the total numbers of misfeed and troubles. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it is judged as necessary for repair. The misfeed rate is obtained by dividing this count value with the total counter value.)
ItemTrouble

Operation/procedure

Each counter data are displayed.

PAPER JAMJAM counter
SPF JAMRSPF JAM counter
TROUBLETrouble counter

The counter display is in 7 digits.

22-3

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of misfeed at each position. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
ItemTroubleMis-feed

Operation/procedure

The misfeed history is displayed in the sequence of recentness by the name of sensors and detectors. Max. 40 items of information can be stored in memory. (The old ones are deleted sequentially.) The trouble section may be determined by the data.

(Jam cause code)

ItemJam contents
TRAY11st tray pick-up miss
TRAY22nd tray pick-up miss
TRAY33rd tray pick-up miss
TRAY44th tray pick-up miss
BPTMulti manual feed pick-up miss
PPD1_NDPaper-in sensor lead edge jam
PPD1_STPaper-in sensor rear edge jam
PPD1_DUPPaper-in sensor reverse jam
PPD2_NDDuplex sensor lead edge jam
PPD2_STDuplex sensor rear edge jam
PPD_PRIPS time out jam
POD3_NDRight paper exit lead edge jam
POD3_STRight paper exit rear edge jam
POD2_NDUpper tray paper exit lead edge jam
POD2_STUpper tray paper exit rear edge jam
POD1_NDLower tray paper exit lead edge jam
POD1_STLower tray paper exit rear edge jam
PINT SHORTAbnormality between PS papers.
PFD2_ND2nd paper pass lead edge jam
PFD2_ST2nd paper pass rear edge jam
PFD3_ND3rd paper pass lead edge jam
PFD3_ST3rd paper pass rear edge jam
PFD4_ND4th paper pass lead edge jam
PFD4_ST4th paper pass rear edge jam
SIZE SHORTDuplex short scale error
FPPD1_NFinisher entry port sensor not-reached jam
FPPD1_SFinisher entry port sensor remaining jam
FSTPD_SFinisher paper exit remaining jam
FSTPLJFinisher staple jam

22-4

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the total trouble (self diag) history.
ItemTrouble

Operation/procedure

The trouble error codes are displayed in the sequence of the latest one first. Max. 40 items of information are stored. (Older ones are deleted in sequence.) The machine condition can be estimated by this data.

22-5

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the ROM version of each unit (section).
ItemSoftware

Operation/procedure

Used to display the ROM version of each section.

[Display example]

ROM version 1.250 [1.25] (up to 2 decimal places)

The display of the protocol monitor and the soft SW follows this display.

S/NMachine serial number
MCUMain Control Unit
IMCIMC
OPEPanel + Panel label code
PRINTERPRINTER
NICNIC
FINISHERFINISHER
FAXFAX
Panel displayDestinationPanel software support language
JPNJapanJapanese, American English, English
EFSSECAmerican English, English, French, Spanish, Brazilian Portuguese
SECL
SUK
SCA/SCNZ
Distributor area
EEUSEEG/SEA/East Europe, etc.English, German, Polish, Czech, Hungarian, Greek, Turkish, Russian, French, Italian, Slovak
NEUSEF/SEES/SEIS/SEN, etc.English, German, French, Spanish, Dutch, Italian, Portuguese, Swedish, Norwegian, Finnish, Danish
CHNSOCCSimplified Chinese, American English, English, Japanese
TWNTaiwanTraditional Chinese (Local support), American English, English
ARBSaudi ArabiaAmerican English, English, French, Spanish, Hebrew (Local support), Arabic
FASIranEnglish, Arabic, Persian, American English, French, Spanish

22-6

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to print each system setting, the account information, and the machine adjustment values.
ItemDataSetting/adjustment data

Operation/Procedure

(Initial screen)

The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.

  1. Select the adjustment item with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

The display is shifted to the copy menu and the set value is stored.

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

After canceling a jam (After picking up, the [C] key is invalid.)

When the other information is repeatedly printed, the display may show the message, "Remove original from original table." However, the operation is performed normally.

ItemContent
1ALLAll lists group print (Default)
2SYSTEM SETTINGSystem setting information list
3ACCOUNTING COUNTERSList of total number of prints
4AUDITOR NO.Department number list
5MACHINE SIM SETTINGMachine simulation setting list
6FAX SIM SETTING*1FAX simulation setting list (Only when the FAX board is installed. The display does not go to the print data transfer display, but to the FAX SIM menu.)
  • When the IMC board is not installed, key input is disabled.
  • Duplex print cannot be made.
  • For the FAX SIM setting list, the display and the operating procedures differ.

Note: When the simulation is canceled, the display returns to the original state but the machine is not reset.

22-7

PurposeUser data output/Check (Display/Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display of the administrator password.
ItemDataUser data

Operation/procedure

Used to display the administrator password.

22-8

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the original, staple counter.
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Each counter is displayed.

SPFRSPF counter
SCANScan counter
STAPLEStapler counter

The counter display is in 7 digits.

22-9

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the number of use of each paper feed section. (the number of prints)
SectionPaper feed
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to display each paper feed counter.

BYPASSManual feed counter
TRAY1Tray 1 counter
TRAY2Tray 2 counter
TRAY3Tray 3 counter
TRAY4Tray 4 counter

The counter display is in 7 digits.

22-10

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the system configuration.
ItemSpecificationsOption

Operation/procedure

The detected machine composition is displayed.

(The job separator cannot be detected. Based on SIM 26-1 setting.)

ItemDisplay items
SPEED26CPM/31CPM
DFNONE/[1: RSPF]
OUTPUTNONE/[2: Finisher]/[3: Job separator]
CASETTE1NONE/[4: One-step paper feed unit]
CASETTE2NONE/[5: Two-step paper feed unit]
IMC MEMNONE/Expansion memory capacity (MB)
PRINTERNONE/[6: PRINTER]
PS3NONE/[7: PS3]
NICNONE/[8: NIC]
SCANNERNONE/[9: SCANNER]
FAXNONE/[10: FAX]
FAX MEMNONE/Memory capacity (MB)
HAND SETNONE/[11: Handset]
USB HOSTNONE/USB HOST
ICCARDR/WNONE/MX-ECX2

NONE: When it is not installed, "---" is displayed.

[ ]: Shows the product code in the list below.

No.ItemModel code
1RSPFMX-RP10
2FinisherMX-FN13
3Job separatorMX-TR11
41 tray paper feed unitMX-DE10 (*1)
52 tray paper feed unitMX-DE11 (*1)
6PRINTERMX-PB12
7PS3MX-PK10
8NICSTANDARD (Only SoftNic)
9SCANNERMX-NSX1
10FAXAR-FX7
11HandsetAR-HN4

*1: The number of installed units is displayed beside the model code.

For the tray, only the option tray is displayed.

22-11

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the FAX send/receive counter (FAX reception and print counter).
SectionFAX
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to display the FAX send/receive counter.

FAX SEND PAGE/TIMEFAX send page and time
FAX RECEIVE PAGE/TIMEFAX receive page and time
FAX OUTPUTFAX output (number of print)

The counter display is in 8 digits.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

22-12

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of misfeed at each position. (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
SectionRSPF
ItemTroubleMisfeed

Operation/procedure

Used to display the RSPF jam history data sequentially from the latest one.

Forty RSPF jam histories are displayed sequentially from the latest.

Error codeNameSensor namePaper Reached/ Not Reached to the sensor
DFD_NDRSPF paper in lead edge jamSPF P-IN sensorNot Reached
DFD_STRSPF paper in rear edge jamSPF P-IN sensorReached
RDD_NDRSPF paper out lead edge jamSPF P-IN sensorReached, P_OUT Not Reached
RDD_STRSPF paper out rear edge jamSPF P-OUT sensorReached, P_IN passed (OFF)
JAM_REVRSPF duplex reverse jamSPF P-IN sensorNot Reached (Paper after reversing)
ORG SHORTRSPF short size errorSPF P-IN sensorPassed (OFF at JAM)
Error codeNameSensor namePaper Reached/Not Reached to the sensor
ORG LONGRSPF long size errorSPF P-OUT sensorReached
SPF P-IN sensorReached

22-13

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the CRUM type.
ItemSpecifications

Operation/Procedure

Used to display the CRUM type.

ItemContent
00Not fixed.
01AR-A
02AR-B
03AR-C
04China
05Japan
99Conversion completed.

22-19

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the scanner counter in the network scanner mode.
SectionNetwork scanner
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to display the scanner counter.

SCANMODEScanner mode counter

The counter display is in 7 digits.

24
24-1

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed history, the trouble counter, and the trouble history. (The counters are cleared after completion of maintenance.)
SectionMemory
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Jam/trouble counter is cleared individually. (The history of each counter is deleted when clearing)

  1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

ItemContent
1JAMJAM counter/JAM history
2SPF JAMRSPF JAM counter/RSPF JAM history
3TROUBLETrouble counter/Trouble history
24-2
PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the number of use (the number of prints) of each paper feed section.
SectionPaper feed
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to clear each paper feed counter individually.

  1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown.
  3. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

ItemContent
1BYPASSManual feed counter
2TRAY1Tray 1 counter
3TRAY2Tray 2 counter
4TRAY3Tray 3 counter
5TRAY4Tray 4 counter

24-3

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the number usage data of the stapler, RSPF, and scanning.
SectionTransport/Finisher
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to clear the original and staple counters individually.

  1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown
  3. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

ItemContent
1SPFRSPF counter
2SCANScan counter
3STAPLEStapler counter

24-4

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to reset the maintenance counter.
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown.
  2. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

24-5
PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to reset the developer counter. (The developer counter of the DV unit which is installed is reset.)
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
ItemCounterDeveloper

Operation/procedure

After execution of SIM25-2, this counter is cleared.

  1. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

24-6

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the copy counter.
ItemCounterCopier

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

24-7

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane decrease) correction counter. (This simulation is executed when the OPC drum is replaced.)
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Photo conductor
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

24-9

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the printer counter and other counters.
SectionPrinter
ItemCounterPrinter

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

ItemContent
1PRINTERPrinter counter
2IMCIMC counter
3DUPLEXDUPLEX counter
4OTHERSThe other counters

24-10

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)FAX counter data clear
SectionFAX
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

  1. Select a counter to be cleared with the 10 key.
  2. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

ItemContent
1FAX SEND (PAGE & TIME)FAX send page and time
2FAX RECEIVE (PAGE & TIME)FAX receive page and time
3FAX OUTPUTFAX output (number of prints)

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

24-15

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the scanner counter in the network scanner mode.
SectionScanner section
ItemCounter

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.

The confirmation menu is shown.

  1. Select "1: YES."

1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)

The scanner mode counter and the number of send of the scanner are cleared.

  • The simulation to perform communication with the PCL is inhibited until Notice Page storing is completed. (Only when the serviceman call error occurs.)
  • When in other than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation is not allowed from the system check display.

25

25-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the main drive (excluding the scanner section) and to check the operation of the toner concentration sensor. (The toner concentration sensor output can be monitored.)
SectionDRIVE
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Press the [START] key.
    The main motor rotates to start monitoring the toner density control sensor. (3min operation)
  2. Even in toner end error, if there is no other error (including cover open) after turning on the power, this simulation can be performed.

25-2

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to make the initial setting of toner concentration when replacing developer.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper

Operation/procedure

After execution, the developer counter is cleared.

1) Open the cover with the power OFF.
2) Turn on the power. (Since the cover is open, the machine does not perform initializing.)
3) Execute the simulation.
4) Enter SIM 25-2. ([25] [START] key [2] [START] key)
5) Close the cover just before starting the simulation.
6) Press the [START] key.

The main motor rotates. After stirring for 3 min, the toner density control sensor value is sampled 16 times, and the average value is stored.

When "EE-EU" or "EE-EL" after completion, an error display is shown.

Note: After completion of execution, be sure to press the [CA] key to cancel the simulation.

26

26-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the job separator is installed or not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware detection, it is set in this simulation.)
ItemSpecificationsOption

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the set value with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.
Set valueConnection option
0None (default)
1Job separator provided.

26-2

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the automatic detection of paper size is made or not.
SectionPaper feed
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the item with the 10-key and press the [START] key. Used to set the automatic size detection.
  2. Set whether automatic detection of paper size is made or not with the 10-key.
1:B4/LG,FCSetting to detect B4/Legal as FC 0: B4 legal is detected as B4 legal. (Default) 1: B4 legal is detected as FC.
2:A4<->LTThis setup detects Letter as A4 in the inch series and A4 as Letter in the AB series. 0: Detection disable (Default) 1: Detection valid

8.5'' × 13'' detection valid/invalid setup

Set valueSetupRemarks
0Detection invalidDefault
1Detection valid

Detection size when 8.5'' × 13'' document/paper is used.

Employed unitDestINATIONDocument sizeSet value
0 (Invalid)1 (Valid)
Docu mentDocument table/RSPFAB seriesFC (8.5" x 13")B4FC (8.5" x 13")
LG (8.5" x 14")B4FC (8.5" x 13")
B4B4FC (8.5" x 13")
Inch seriesFC (8.5" x 13")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
LG (8.5" x 14")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
B4WLT (11" x 17")WLT (11" x 17")
PaperMachine paper feed trayAll destinations-Set with system setting.
Manual paper feed trayAB seriesFC (8.5" x 13")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
LG (8.5" x 14")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
B4B4B4
Inch seriesFC (8.5" x 13")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
LG (8.5" x 14")LG (8.5" x 14")FC (8.5" x 13")
B4B4B4

A4/LT (8.5" x 11") detection enable/disable setup
In the inch series, Letter is detected as A4; in the AB series, A4 is detected as Letter.

Set valueSetupRemarks
0Detection invalidDefault
1Detection valid

Detection size when A4/LT (8.5" x 11") document/paper is used.

Employed unitDestina-tionDocument sizeSet value
0 (Invalid)1 (Valid)
Docu-mentDocument table/RSPFAB seriesA4A4LT (8.5" x 11")
LT (8.5" x 11")A4LT (8.5" x 11")
Inch seriesA4LT (8.5" x 11")A4
LT (8.5" x 11")LT (8.5" x 11")A4
PaperMachine paper feed trayAll destina-tions-Set with system setting.
Manual paper feed trayAll destina-tions-Regardless of the simulation setup.
26-3
PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the specifications of the auditor. Setting must be made depending on the use condition of the auditor.
SectionAuditor
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

Select the mode corresponding to the auditor specification mode with the 10-key.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0P10Built-in auditor mode0-20
1VENDORCoin vendor mode
2OTHEROthers

When "1: VENDOR (Coin vendor mode)" is set, the following three items of system setting are changed.

1) Set the LCD backlight change inhibit to "1: OFF (Enable)."
2) When SIM 26-6 destination setting is set to "0: Japan," duplex copy inhibit setting must be set to "0: ON (Inhibit)."
3) Set the sort automatic selection to "0: OFF (Disable)."

26-5

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the count mode of the total counter and the maintenance counter.
ItemSpecificationsCounter

Operation/procedure

Used to set the count up number (1 or 2) when an A3/WT paper passes through.

For the drum counter and the developer counter, double count is employed unconditionally.

(Target counter selection)

ItemContent
1TOTAL COUNTERTotal counter
2MAINTENANCE COUNTERMaintenance counter

Used to set the count up number of the selected counter.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1SINGLE COUNTSingle count1-22
2DOUBLE COUNTDouble count

26-6

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the specifications depending on the destination.
ItemSpecificationsDestination

Operation/procedure

Select the destination with the 10-key.

By changing the destination, some other setting items may be changed.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0JAPANJapan0-140
1SECSEC
2SECLSECL
3SEEGSEEG
4SUKSUK
5SCASCA
6SEFSEF
7INEGEX inch series
8ABEGEX AB series
9INEFEX inch series (FC)
10ABEFEX AB series (FC)
11CHINESEChina
12TAIWANTaiwan AB
13SEEG2SEEG2
14TAIWAN2Taiwan China

26-12

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC.
SectionE-MAIL RIC
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

The current setup is displayed with ON or OFF.

Enter an input (20 digits) of the E-MAIL RIC soft key with the 10-key and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed with OK or NG.

After canceling the simulation, if OK, the E-MAIL RIC function is enable; if NG, the E-MAIL RIC function is disabled.

This setting must be reset after the simulation cancel.

26-14

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to input the Software Key for the PS extension kit.
SectionPrinter
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

The current setup is displayed with ON or OFF.

Enter an input (20 digits) of the PS expansion kit soft key with the 10-key and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed with OK or NG.

After canceling the simulation, if OK, the PS expansion kit function is enable; if NG, the PS expansion kit function is disabled.

This setting must be reset after the simulation cancel.

Note: Executable only when the PCL/PS3 is installed.

26-18

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation.
ItemSpecificationsOperation mode (Common)

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0OFFDisable0-11
1ONEnable

26-22

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the specification (language display) for the destination.
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

Select the display language with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).

ItemRemarks
0JAPANESE
1ENG.US
2ENG. UK
3FRENCH
4GERMAN
5ITALY
6DUTCH
7SWEDISH
8SPANISH
ItemRemarks
9PORTUGUESE
10TURKISH
11GREEK
12POLISH
13HUNGARIAN
14CZECH
15RUSSIAN
16FINNISH
17NORWEGIAN
18DANISH
19CHINESE
20TAIWANESETraditional Chinese supported locally
21SLOVAK
22HEBREWSupported locally
23BRAZILIAN PORTUGUESE
24ARABIC
25Farsi

26-30

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up control conforming to the CE mark control.
ItemSpecificationsOperation mode (Common)

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).

ItemDefault
U.S.A, Canada, Australia, France, TaiwanOthers
0OFF01
1ON

26-35

PurposeSetup
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the same continuous troubles are displayed as one trouble or the series of troubles with SIM 22-4 when the same troubles occur continuously.
ItemSpecifications

Operation/procedure

Enter the set value with 10-key, and press [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
0ONCEWhen two or more troubles occur, only one is registered.0
1ANYAll the troubles occurred are registered.

26-36

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the maintenance counter life is expired.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
0STOPStop1
1NON STOPNon stop

26-37

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the developer counter life is expired.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
0STOPStop1
1NON STOPNon stop

26-38

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not when the drum counter life is expired.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
0STOPStop1
1NON STOPNon stop

26-50

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white reversion function.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
0ONEnable1 (U.K.)
1OFFDisable0 (Others)

26-56

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Gamma life correction setting
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Sets enable/disable of the gamma life correction function.

ItemSet valueDefault
1AE (Japan)0: Disable 1: Enable0
2AE (Ex Japan)0
3Text1
4Text/Photo1
5Photo (Error diffusion)1
6Photo (Dither)1
7T/S AE (Japan)0
8T/S AE (Ex Japan)0
9T/S Text1
10T/S Text/Photo1

26-57

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the model code.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

Item
1AR-5726
2AR-5731

26-60

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key when FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed, the FAX mode is enabled regardless of this setup.)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
U.S.A, Canada, U.K., AustraliaOthers
0ONEffective (The message with FAX uninstalled is displayed.)01
1OFFDisable (Error Beep)

This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).

26-71

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (pre-heat mode setting) and the auto power shut off time can be set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1 min, auto power shut off: 1 min) and the long time setup (pre-heat: 5min, auto power shut off: 30min).

Operation/procedure

Select the short time setup or the long time setup of the pre-heat time and the auto power shut off time with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
1Preheat: 1min, auto power shut off: 1min1
2Preheat: 5min, auto power shut off: 30min

Note: When the sub code 71 is entered to display the setting menu, the default values are always displayed. (However, the default time is not always set.)

26-72

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)The letterhead support is set. When “Letterhead paper setting” is selected, the set value of SIM 26-46 (Image output direction setting) is set to “Setting Enable” accordingly.

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0OFFLetterhead paper is not set.0-10
1ONLetterhead paper is set.

30

30-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to display the sensor status attached to the machine.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

PPD1HPS paper detection 1 sensor
PPD1LPS paper detection 2 sensor
PPD2Fusing paper sensor
POD11st paper exit paper out sensor
DVCHDeveloping cartridge detection sensor
DRSTDrum initial detection sensor
DSWR1Interlock switch (side door)
SFTHPShifter home position sensor
POD22nd paper exit paper out sensor
TOPF2nd paper exit full detection sensor
DSWR02nd paper exit cover open/close detection sensor
LOEMP1st paper exit empty detection sensor
DUP2Reverse path paper sensor
POD3Right paper exit sensor
PTOPFRight paper exit full sensor

30-2

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to display the status of the sensors attached to the standard tray and the manual feed tray. (Use SIM 4-2 for the option trays.)The sensor of an uninstalled tray is not displayed.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

PED11st tray paper empty sensor
LUD11st tray paper upper limit detection sensor
CD11st tray empty sensor
PED22nd tray paper empty sensor
LUD22nd tray paper upper limit detection sensor
CD22nd tray empty sensor
PFD22nd tray paper pass sensor
DSWR22nd tray right door detection sensor
MPEDManual tray paper empty detection
MPLS1Manual tray length detection 1
MPLS2Manual tray length detection 2
MPLD1Manual feed paper length detection 1
MPLD2Manual feed paper length detection 2

Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.) A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA, 8K/16K

(At detection, highlighted)

40

40-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the sensor of the machine manual feed tray.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

MPLS1Manual tray length detection 1
MPLS2Manual tray length detection 2
MPLD1Manual feed paper length detection 1
MPLD2Manual feed paper length detection 2

Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.) A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA, 8K/16K

40-2

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper width detector detection level.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The adjustment method is of the 4-point system. Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position, and Min. position for adjustment.

1) Set A3/W Letter and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
2) Set A4R/LetterR and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
3) Set to A5R/INVOICE R and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
4) Narrow the guide at minimum, press the [START] key.
5) Set the paper detection width (+) , and press the [START] key.

6) Set the paper detection width (-) , and press the [START] key.

If "FAILED" is displayed in procedure 1), 2), 3), or 4), it is NG of adjustment. Repeat the adjustment.

Middle position adjustment LYesMID-L ADJ.ON
NoMID-L ADJ.OFF
Middle position adjustment SYesNID-S ADJ.ON
NoMID-S ADJ.OFF

40-3

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)The AD conversion value of manual feed width detection is displayed.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The AD conversion value of manual feed width detection is displayed.

41

41-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the document size detection photo sensor.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The operation status of the sensors and detectors in the original size detection section are displayed. The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.

OCSWOriginal cover state Open: Highlighted display Close: Normal display
PD1 to 5Original sensor status Without original: Normal display With original: Highlighted display

For AB series, PD1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, PD1 to 4.

41-2

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the detection level of the document size photo sensor.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Place an A3 (or WLT) document on the document table, and press [START] key with the OC cover open.

The adjustment is performed and the result is displayed.

OCSWOriginal cover state Open: Highlighted display Close: Normal display
1 to 5PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display)

The value in [ ] shows the threshold value. (Hexadecimal display)

For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4.

During execution of the simulation, "EXECUTING" is displayed.

41-3

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the light reception level and the detection level of the original size detection photo sensor.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time.

OCSWOriginal cover state Open: Highlighted display Close: Normal display
1 to 5PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display)

The value in [ ] shows the threshold value of 20 degree detection adjustment. (Hexadecimal display)

For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4.

41-4

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20 degrees.
SectionOthers
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Set the OC cover at 20 degrees detection and press the [START] key. The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time.

OCSWOriginal cover state Open: Highlighted display Close: Normal display
1 to 5PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display)

The value in [ ] shows the threshold value of 20 degree detection adjustment. (Hexadecimal display)

For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4.

During execution, [EXECUTING] is highlighted.

43

43-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the fusing temperature.
SectionFixing (Fusing)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be set.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
(Others)(Europe)
1Ready Temp Main (145)Ready temperature Main (145mm/s)150 - 220185190
2Ready Temp Sub (145)Ready temperature Sub (145mm/s)150 - 220180185
3Ready Temp Main (122)Ready temperature Main (122mm/s)150 - 220175180
4Ready Temp Sub (122)Ready temperature Sub (122mm/s)150 - 220170175
5WarmUp Target Main (145)Warmup target temperature Main (145mm/s)150 - 220180190
6WarmUp Target Sub (145)Warmup target temperature Sub (145mm/s)150 - 220180190
7WarmUp Target Main (122)Warmup target temperature Main (122mm/s)150 - 220175
8WarmUp Target Sub (122)Warmup target temperature Sub (122mm/s)150 - 220170
9WarmUp Temp Main (145)Warmup complete temperature Main (145mm/s)0 - 4010
10WarmUp Temp Sub (145)Warmup complete temperature Sub (145mm/s)0 - 4015
11WarmUp Temp Main (122)Warmup complete temperature Main (122mm/s)0 - 4010
12WarmUp Temp Sub (122)Warmup complete temperature Sub (122mm/s)0 - 4015
13600dpi Main (145)600dpi Main (145mm/s)150 - 220190195
14600dpi Sub (145)600dpi Sub (145mm/s)150 - 220190195
15POST CARD Main (145)Postcard Main (145mm/s)150 - 220200
16POST CARD Sub (145)Postcard Sub (145mm/s)150 - 220200
17CARDBOA RD Main (145)Thick paper Main (145mm/s)150 - 220200
18CARDBOA RD Sub (145)Thick paper Sub (145mm/s)150 - 220200
19600dpi Main (122)600dpi Main (122mm/s)150 - 220175185
20600dpi Sub (122)600dpi Sub (122mm/s)150 - 220175185
21CARDBOA RD Main (122)Postcard Main (122mm/s)150 - 220190
22POST CARD Sub (122)Postcard Sub (122mm/s)150 - 220190
23POST CARD (122mm/s)Thick paper Main (122mm/s)150 - 220190
24CARDBOA RD Sub (122)Thick paper Sub (122mm/s)150 - 220190
43-10
PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when printing postcards.
SectionPaper feed
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.

Setting range1-99
Default50

44

44-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to make various setups in each mode of process control.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

ItemContentDefault
1ENVIRONMENT ADJ.Environmental correction Allow/Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)1
2DUPLEX PRINT ADJ.Duplex print correction Allow/Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)0
3ENVIROMENT ADJ (TC)Transfer current enviroment correction Allow/Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)0

44-2

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Drum life correction setting
SectionImage process (Photoconductor)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select an item with 10-key, and press [START] key.
  2. Enter the setting value, and press [START] key.
ItemContentDefault
1GRIDBIASADJUSTDrum life correction Disable/Enable(0: Disable, 1: Enable)1

44-3

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the DV count correction.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select an item with 10-key, and press [START] key.
  2. Enter the setting value, and press [START] key.
ItemContentDefault
1PR_LIFE_ADJUSTDV count correction Disable/Enable (0: Disable, 1: Enable)1
2TN_LIFE_ADJUSTLife of toner control DV correction Disable/Enable (0: Disable, 1: Enable)1
3RATE_ADJUSTPrinting rate correction Disable/Enable (0: Disable, 1: Enable)1
4TONER_ADJUSTToner unconditionally supply correction Disable/Enable (0: Disable, 1: Enable)1
44-9
PurposeAdjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check (Display/Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the process control correction information.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Used to display the process control correction information.

44-14
PurposeAdjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check (Display/Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the environment (temperature, humidity) correction information.
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The following data are displayed.

TH AREACurrent environment area
TMP DATADetection temperature of sensor (C°)
HUD DATADetection humidity of sensor (%)
  • The value before entry of SIM is displayed. (It is not revised in real time.)

If sim entry is just after power turned on, the display value is all 0.

44-16
PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the toner density control correction value.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Sets the toner density control correction value of the traveling distance count.

ItemSetting rangeDefault
10 - 93000(31-sheet model)1-9945
293001 - 186000(31-sheet model)1-9945
3186001 - 279000(31-sheet model)1-9945
4279001 - 372000(31-sheet model)1-9945
5372001 - 465000(31-sheet model)1-9945
ItemSetting rangeDefault
6465001 - 857313(31-sheet model)1-9945
7857314 - 1714625(31-sheet model)1-9945
81714626 - 2571938(31-sheet model)1-9945
92571939 - 3429250(31-sheet model)1-9945
103429251 - 4286563(31-sheet model)1-9945
114286564 - 5143875(31-sheet model)1-9945
125143876 - 6001188(31-sheet model)1-9945
136001189 - 6858500(31-sheet model)1-9945
146858501 - 7715813(31-sheet model)1-9945
157715814 - 8573125(31-sheet model)1-9945
168573126 - 9430438(31-sheet model)1-9945
179430439 - 10287750(31-sheet model)1-9945
1810287751 - 11145063(31-sheet model)1-9945
1911145064 - 12002375(31-sheet model)1-9945
2012002376 -(31-sheet model)1-9945
210 - 93000(26-sheet model)1-9945
2293001 - 186000(26-sheet model)1-9945
23186001 - 279000(26-sheet model)1-9945
24279001 - 372000(26-sheet model)1-9945
25372001 - 465000(26-sheet model)1-9945
26465001 - 857313(26-sheet model)1-9945
27857314 - 1714625(26-sheet model)1-9945
281714626 - 2571938(26-sheet model)1-9945
292571939 - 3429250(26-sheet model)1-9945
303429251 - 4286563(26-sheet model)1-9945
314286564 - 5143875(26-sheet model)1-9945
325143876 - 6001188(26-sheet model)1-9945
336001189 - 6858500(26-sheet model)1-9945
346858501 - 7715813(26-sheet model)1-9945
357715814 - 8573125(26-sheet model)1-9945
368573126 - 9430438(26-sheet model)1-9945
379430439 - 10287750(26-sheet model)1-9945
3810287751 - 11145063(26-sheet model)1-9945
3911145064 - 12002375(26-sheet model)1-9945
4012002376 -(26-sheet model)1-9945
44-17
PurposeAdjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check (Display/Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to display the toner density control reference value.
SectionImage process ( Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The following data are displayed. (The displayed value is the previous print correction value.)

TARGETToner concentration control reference value
DEV REFDeveloper adjustment value
LIFEToner container life correction value (SIM 44-16)
THToner container environment correction value

TARGET = DEVREF+(LIFE-50)+(TH-50)

Developer adjustment value 128, life correction 60 (developer adjustment value plus 10), environment correction 45 (5 subtraction correction), rapid toner supply correction = 128 + (60 - 50) + (45 - 50) = 133. )

44-34

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the transfer current value in each mode.

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be set.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.

To support an individual necessity in paper and the environment, it is variable in the range of 5 to 30 A in the increment of 1uA in each mode.

When changing +V2 , check with +V1 unchanged. If there is any trouble in the half tone image of graphics, keep the relationship between +V1 and +V2 at the default and change it.

When the image quality is deteriorated because the user selects the OHP mode and use other than the recommended OHP, decrease the transfer current to adjust deterioration of black background picture quality. If some of characters are not printed, increase the transfer current.

This setting is changed in linkage with SIM 26-6 destination setting.

*1: SECL/SCA/SEF/EX inch series/EX AB series/EX inch series (FC)/ EX AB series (FC)/China/Taiwan/SEEG2

*2: SEC/SEEG/SUK

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
*1*2
1+V1F (145)145mm/s normal paper W +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
2+V1R (145)145mm/s normal paper W +V1 Duplex (Back)5-305
3+V2F (145)145mm/s normal paper W +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-301820
4+V2R (145)145mm/s normal paper W +V2 Duplex (Back)5-301418
5+V1S-F (145)145mm/s normal paper N1 +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
6+V1S-R (145)145mm/s normal paper N1 +V1 Duplex (Back)5-305
7+V2S-F (145)145mm/s normal paper N1 +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-3018
8+V2S-R (145)145mm/s normal paper N1 +V2 Duplex (Back)5-3018
9+V1SS-F (145)145mm/s normal paper N2 +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
10+V1SS-R (145)145mm/s normal paper N2 +V1 Duplex (Back)5-305
11+V1SS-F (145)145mm/s normal paper N2 +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-3018
12+V1SS-R (145)145mm/s normal paper N2 +V2 Duplex (Back)5-3018
13+V1 THICK (145)145mm/s thick paper > LTR +V15-305
14+V2 THICK (145)145mm/s thick paper > LTR +V25-3014
15+V1 THICK S (145)145mm/s thick paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
16+V2 THICK S (145)145mm/s thick paper ≤ LTR +V25-3014
17+V1 THIN (145)145mm/s thin paper > LTR +V15-305
18+V2 THIN (145)145mm/s thin paper > LTR +V25-3018
19+V1 THIN S (145)145mm/s thin paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
20+V2 THIN S (145)145mm/s thin paper ≤ LTR +V25-3018
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
*1*2
21+V1 LABEL (145)145mm/s label paper > LTR +V15-305
22+V2 LABEL (145)145mm/s label paper > LTR +V25-3018
23+V1 LABEL S (145)145mm/s label paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
24+V2 LABEL S (145)145mm/s label paper ≤ LTR +V25-3014
25+V1 OHP (145)145mm/s OHP > LTR +V15-305
26+V2 OHP(145)145mm/s OHP > LTR +V25-3014
27+V1 OHP S (145)145mm/s OHP ≤ LTR +V15-305
28+V2 OHP S (145)145mm/s OHP ≤ LTR +V25-3018
29+V1 POSTCARD (145)145mm/s postcard/envelope > 100mm +V15-305
30+V2 POSTCARD (145)145mm/s postcard/envelope > 100mm +V25-3026
31+V1 POSTCARD S (145)145mm/s postcard/envelope ≤ 100mm +V15-305
32+V2 POSTCARD S (145)145mm/s postcard/envelope ≤ 100mm +V25-3026
33+V1F (122)122mm/s normal paper W +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
34+V1R (122)122mm/s normal paper W +V1 Duplex (Back)5-305
35+V2F (122)122mm/s normal paper W +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-301214
36+V2R (122)122mm/s normal paper W +V2 Duplex (Back)5-3012
37+V1S-F (122)122mm/s normal paper N1 +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
38+V1S-R (122)122mm/s normal paper N1 +V1 Duplex (Back)5-305
39+V2S-F (122)122mm/s normal paper N1 +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-3014
40+V2S-R (122)122mm/s normal paper N1 +V2 Duplex (Back)5-3014
41+V1SS-F (122)122mm/s normal paper N2 +V2 Duplex (Back)5-305
42+V1SS-R (122)122mm/s normal paper N2 +V1 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-305
43+V2SS-F (122)122mm/s normal paper N2 +V1 Duplex (Back)5-3014
44+V2SS-R (122)122mm/s normal paper N2 +V2 single surface. Duplex (Front)5-3014
45+V1 THICK (122)122mm/s thick paper > LTR +V15-305
46+V2 THICK (122)122mm/s thick paper > LTR +V25-3010
47+V1 THICK S (122)122mm/s thick paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
48+V2 THICK S (122)122mm/s thick paper ≤ LTR +V25-3012
49+V1 THIN (122)122mm/s thin paper > LTR +V15-305
50+V2 THIN (122)122mm/s thin paper > LTR +V25-3012
51+V1 THIN S (122)122mm/s thin paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
52+V2 THIN S (122)122mm/s thin paper ≤ LTR +V25-3012
53+V1 LABEL (122)122mm/s label paper > LTR +V15-305
54+V2 LABEL (122)122mm/s label paper > LTR +V25-3012
55+V1 LABEL S (122)122mm/s label paper ≤ LTR +V15-305
56+V2 LABEL S (122)122mm/s label paper ≤ LTR +V25-3012
57+V1 OHP (122)122mm/s OHP > LTR +V15-305
58+V2 OHP (122)122mm/s OHP > LTR +V25-308
59+V1 OHP S (122)122mm/s OHP ≤ LTR +V15-305
60+V2 OHP S (122)122mm/s OHP ≤ LTR +V25-3012
61+V1 POSTCARD (122)122mm/s postcard/envelope > 100mm +V15-305
62+V2 POSTCARD (122)122mm/s postcard/envelope > 100mm +V25-3016
63+V1 POSTCARD S (122)122mm/s postcard/envelope ≤ 100mm +V15-305
64+V2 POSTCARD S (122)122mm/s postcard/envelope ≤ 100mm +V25-3016

44-40

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the time from the start of the main motor rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply in previous rotation after turning on the power.

Operation/procedure

Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

Set the toner supply previous rotation time.

Setting range1-99 (sec)
Default4 (sec)

46

46-2

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to set the exposure level in each exposure mode.
ItemPicture qualityDensity

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted. (Automatic adjustment)
    The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.
  2. Press the [START] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
  4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

(Exposure mode)

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AEAE1-9950
2TEXTCharacter Level 3.0
3TEXT/PROTOCharacter/Photo Level 3.0
4PHOTOPhoto Level 3.0
5AE(TS)AE (TS)
6TEXT(TS)Character (TS) Level 3.0
7TEXT/PROTO(TS)Character/Photo (TS) Level 3.0
  • Except for AE and AE (TS), only Level 3 can be set.
    Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial menu but the machine is not reset.

46-9

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Text).
ItemPicture qualityDensity

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Press the [START] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
  4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

(Exposure mode (Text))

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
11.0 (SHIFT)Character level 1.0 (shift q'ty)1-9922
21.0 (GAMMA)Character level 1.0 (slant)1-9944
32.0 (SHIFT)Character level 2.0 (shift q'ty)1-9936
42.0 (GAMMA)Character level 2.0 (slant)1-9947
53.0 (SHIFT)Character level 3.0 (shift q'ty)1-9950
63.0 (GAMMA)Character level 3.0 (slant)1-9950
74.0 (SHIFT)Character level 4.0 (shift q'ty)1-9961
84.0 (GAMMA)Character level 4.0 (slant)1-9955
95.0 (SHIFT)Character level 5.0 (shift q'ty)1-9972
105.0 (GAMMA)Character level 5.0 (slant)1-9960
11TS 1.0 (SHIFT)Character (TS) level 1.0 (shift q'ty)1-9922
121TS 1.0 (GAMMA)Character (TS) level 1.0 (slant)1-9944
13TS 2.0 (SHIFT)Character (TS) level 2.0 (shift q'ty)1-9936
14TS 2.0 (GAMMA)Character (TS) level 2.0 (slant)1-9947
15TS 3.0 (SHIFT)Character (TS) level 3.0 (shift q'ty)1-9950
16TS 3.0 (GAMMA)Character (TS) level 3.0 (slant)1-9950
17TS 4.0 (SHIFT)Character (TS) level 4.0 (shift q'ty)1-9961
18TS 4.0 (GAMMA)Character (TS) level 4.0 (slant)1-9955
19TS 5.0 (SHIFT)Character (TS) level 5.0 (shift q'ty)1-9972
20TS 5.0 (GAMMA)Character (TS) level 5.0 (slant)1-9960

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial menu but the machine is not reset.

46-10

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Text/Photo).
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Press the [START] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
  4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

(Exposure mode (Text/Photo))

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
11.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo level 1.0 (shift q'ty)1-9930
21.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo level 1.0 (slant)1-9937
32.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo level 2.0 (shift q'ty)1-9940
42.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo level 2.0 (slant)1-9943
53.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo level 3.0 (shift q'ty)1-9950
63.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo level 3.0 (slant)1-9950
74.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo level 4.0 (shift q'ty)1-9957
84.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo level 4.0 (slant)1-9961
95.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo level 5.0 (shift q'ty)1-9964
105.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo level 5.0 (slant)1-9966
11TS 1.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo (TS) level 1.0 (shift q'ty)1-9930
12TS 1.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo (TS) level 1.0 (slant)1-9937
13TS 2.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo (TS) level 2.0 (shift q'ty)1-9940
14TS 2.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo (TS) level 2.0 (slant)1-9943
15TS 3.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo (TS) level 3.0 (shift q'ty)1-9950
16TS 3.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo (TS) level 3.0 (slant)1-9950
17TS 4.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo (TS) level 4.0 (shift q'ty)1-9957
18TS 4.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo (TS) level 4.0 (slant)1-9961
19TS 5.0 (SHIFT)Character/Photo (TS) level 5.0 (shift q'ty)1-9964
20TS 5.0 (GAMMA)Character/Photo (TS) level 5.0 (slant)1-9966

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial menu but the machine is not reset.

46-11

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode (Photo).
ItemPicture qualityDensity

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Press the [START] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
  4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

(Exposure mode (Photo))

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
11.0(SHIFT)Photo level 1.0 (shift q'ty)1-9916
21.0(GAMMA)Photo level 1.0 (slant)50
32.0(SHIFT)Photo level 2.0 (shift q'ty)33
42.0(GAMMA)Photo level 2.0 (slant)50
53.0(SHIFT)Photo level 3.0 (shift q'ty)50
63.0(GAMMA)Photo level 3.0 (slant)50
74.0(SHIFT)Photo level 4.0 (shift q'ty)56
84.0(GAMMA)Photo level 4.0 (slant)61
95.0(SHIFT)Photo level 5.0 (shift q'ty)62
105.0(GAMMA)Photo level 5.0 (slant)66

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial menu but the machine is not reset.

46-12

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX exposure level adjustment (1 mode automatic adjustment)
SectionFAX
ItemImage quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Select "1: COPY START." The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
  2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and press the [# /P] key.
  3. Press the [START] key. Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

ItemSetting rangeDefault
1COPY START--
2FAX EXP.LEVEL0-9950

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

46-13

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX exposure level adjustment (Normal mode individual adjustment)
SectionFAX
ItemImage quality

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key. Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2EXP.LEVELExposure level selection0-9950
3AENormal text AE
4MANUALNormal text MANUAL

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

46-14

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX exposure level adjustment (Fine text mode individual adjustment)
SectionFAX
ItemImage quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Select "1: COPY START."

The currently set value is displayed beside the item.

  1. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and press the [# /P] key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started and the set value is stored.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2EXP.LEVALExposure level selection0-9950
3AE (PHOTO ON)Fine text AE (Half tone)
4AE (PHOTO OFF)Fine text AE
5MANUAL (PHOTO ON)Fine text MANUAL (Half tone)
6MANUAL (PHOTO OFF)Fine text MANUAL

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

46-15

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX exposure level adjustment (Super Fine mode individual adjustment)
SectionFAX
ItemImage quality

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started and the set value is stored.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2EXP.LEVELExposure level selection0-9950
3AE (PHOTO ON)Super Fine AE (Half tone)
4AE (PHOTO OFF)Super Fine AE
5MANUAL (PHOTO ON)Super Fine MANUAL (Half tone)
6MANUAL (PHOTO OFF)Super Fine MANUAL

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

46-16

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX exposure level adjustment (Ultra Fine mode individual adjustment)
SectionFAX
ItemImage quality

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started and the set value is stored.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2EXP.LEVELExposure level selection0-9950
3AE (PHOTO ON)Ultra Fine AE (Half tone)
4AE (PHOTO OFF)Ultra Fine AE
5MANUAL (PHOTO ON)Ultra Fine MANUAL (Half tone)
6MANUAL (PHOTO OFF)Ultra Fine MANUAL

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

46-18

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.

The adjustment item and the current set value are highlighted.

  1. Press the [START] key.

The display is shifted to the copy menu.

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.

Set the exposure level with the 10-key.

  1. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

(Auto adjustment)

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1AEAE1-9950
2TEXTCharacterLevel 3.0
3TEXT/PROTOCharacter/PhotoLevel 3.0
4PHOTOPhotoLevel 3.0
5AE(TS)AE(TS)
6TEXT(TS)Character (TS)Level 3.0
7TEXT/PROTO(TS)Character/Photo (TS)Level 3.0

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial menu but the machine is not reset.

46-19

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to set the control method of the exposure mode.
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.

The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.

  1. Press the [START] key.
    The display is shifted to the adjustment value entry menu.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the display returns to the original state (adjustment item selection menu).

ItemContentDefault
1AE MODE (1:EXPOSURE 2:TONER)Auto exposure mode* (1: Priority on Image quality, 2: Priority on toner consumption)2
2AE STOP(COPY) (0:FIXED 1:REAL TIME)Auto exposure STOP mode (COPY) (0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)0
3AE MODE(FAX) (0:FIXED 1:REAL TIME)Auto exposure STOP mode (FAX) (0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)0
4AE STOP(SCAN) (0:FIXED 1:REAL TIME)Auto exposure STOP mode (SCANNER) (0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)0
5PHOTO MODEPhoto mode (1: ED (Error diffusion), 2: DT (Dither))2
  • Auto exposure mode
  • When SIM 26-6 (Destination setup) is changed from EX Japan to Japan, the setup value becomes 1 (Default: Japan). If, on the contrary, it is changed from Japan to EX Japan, the set value becomes 2 (Default: EX Japan)
  • If the auto exposure mode setup value is changed, the setup value of SIM 46-30 (AE limit setup) is reset to the default value.

46-20

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/RSPF for OC exposure.
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1SPF EXPOSURESPF1-9953
2RSPF EXPOSURERSPF

46-30

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner save).

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
    If SIM 26-6 (Destination setup) and SIM46-19 (Auto exposure mode) are changed, this setup is also changed to the default value accordingly.
ItemSetting rangeDefault
1AE0-310
2AE(TS)

46-31

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE (Toner save).

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.

The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.

  1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
ItemSetting rangeDefault
1AE0-21
2TEXT
3TEXT/PHOTO
4PHOTO

46-39

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to switch the FAX send image quality.

Enter the set value with the 10-key.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0HAIRLINEOriginal with pencil lines and thin lines0-10
1PRINTERPrinted original

48

48-1

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio (main scanning direction, sub scanning direction).
SectionImage processing
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be set.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Press the [START] key.
    The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
  4. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1F-RMain scanning magnification ratio adjustment1-9950
2SCANSub scanning magnification ratio adjustment60
3SPF (SIDE1)RSPF surface sub scan magnification ratio50
4SPF (SIDE2)RSPF back surface sub scan magnification ratio
5DUPLEXDUPLEX sub scanning magnification ratio adjustment
6MirSpeedMirror speed adjustment

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

48-2
PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification ratio (main/sub scanning direction).
SectionImage processing
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be set.

The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
4. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1F-RMain scanning magnification ratio adjustment1-9950
2SCANSub scanning magnification ratio adjustment
3SPF (SIDE1)RSPF surface sub scan magnification ratio
4SPF (SIDE2)RSPF back surface sub scan magnification ratio

48-3

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the print mode magnification ratio correction.
SectionImage processing
ItemPicture quality

Operation/procedure

  1. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.

  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.

Changes magnification ratio by changing speed of main motor.

The change of the paper transfer speed is 0.1% when changing value is 1.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1145mm/sMain motor speed (145mm/s)45-5550
2122mm/sMain motor speed (122mm/s)

48-8

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX magnification adjustment (read)
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the magnification ratio adjustment with the 10 key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started and the set value is stored.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no operation of tray selection.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

Even when the SPF/RSPF is selected, if there is no original on the SPF/RSPF, the OC is scanned.

Even when the OC is selected, if there is any original on the SPF/RSPF, the SPF/RSPF is scanned. (Setting 2)

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2SCAN SELECT (OC/SPF/RSPF)Scan selection (OC/ SPF/RSPF)1-255*128
3OC(MAIN)SCAN Main scanning magnification ratio adjustment (OC)1-255*128
4OC(SUB)SCAN Sub scanning magnification ratio adjustment (OC)1-255*128
5SPF(MAIN)SCAN Main scanning magnification ratio adjustment (SPF)1-255*128
6SPF(SUB)SCAN Sub scanning magnification ratio adjustment (SPF)1-255*128
7RSPF(MAIN)SCAN Main scanning magnification ratio adjustment (RSPF)1-255*128
8RSPF(SUB)SCAN Sub scanning magnification ratio adjustment (RSPF)1-255*128
  • The adjustment can be made in the range of -12.7% - +12.7% by the increment of 0.1%.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

48-9

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX magnification adjustment (print)
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the magnification ratio correction with the 10 key.
  3. Press the [START] key.
Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no operation of tray selection.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

When two pages are scanned, duplex printing is made.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start1-255128
2HorizontalPrint magnification ratio adjustment (Horizontal, vertical to paper passing)1-255128
3VerticalPrint magnification ratio adjustment (Vertical, parallel to paper passing)1-255128
4Horizontal (DUPLEX)Print magnification ratio adjustment on the back surface (Horizontal, vertical to paper passing)1-255128
5Vertical (DUPLEX)Print magnification ratio adjustment on the back surface (Vertical, parallel to paper passing)1-255128

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

50-1

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the copy lead edge position.
ItemPicture qualityImage position

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key., The display goes to the copy menu.
    When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying state and print is started.

(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.

Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.

  1. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

(Adjustment procedure)

  1. Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and change the value to 99.
  2. Set SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) to 1. (By setting to 1, there is no void.)
  3. Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC document table.
  4. Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
  5. Reset the adjustment values of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4) to the original values, and execute test print. Check the print out and adjust so that the lead edge image is printed on the lead edge of paper. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step).
  6. Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the print out is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
  7. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
  8. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 8, 9) so that the left edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
  9. Make an enlargement copy (400%), and check that there is no shade of the cabinet printed at the lead edge.
  10. If there is a shade printed at the lead edge in procedure 9, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 10). (1 - 5: About 0.677mm )

  11. If there is no problem, set to 2.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1RRC-AOriginal scan start position adjustment Lead edge position adjustment value (OC)1-9943
2DEN-ALead edge cancel adjustment (Main tray)1-9918
3DEN-A-MANUALLead edge cancel adjustment (Manual feed tray)1-9918
4DEN-A -OPTIONLead edge cancel adjustment (Option tray)1-9918
5DEN-A -DUPLEXLead edge cancel adjustment (back of the machine)1-9918
6DEN-BRear edge void adjustment1-9930
7DEN-B-DUPRear edge void adjustment (Duplex)1-9950
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
8SIDE VOIDLeft edge void adjustment (First print surface)1-9918
9SIDE VOID-DUPLeft edge void adjustment (Duplex)1-9918
10LOSS(OC)Image loss amount adjustment (Lead edge image loss set value) (OC)1-53

50-5

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on the print paper in the print mode.
ItemPicture qualityPrint area

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.

The item and the currently set value are highlighted.

  1. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key. The display goes to the copy menu.

When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying state and print is started.

(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1TRAY11st tray0-9953
2OPTIONOption tray1-99
3MANUALManual feed
4DUPLEXBack print

50-6

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on print paper in the copy mode. (RSPF)
ItemPicture qualityImage position

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.

The item and the currently set value are highlighted.

  1. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key. The display goes to the copy menu.

When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying state and print is started.

(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1SIDE1Surface original scan start position adjustment1-9950
2SIDE2Back original scan start position set1-9950
3END EDGERear edge void adjustment (RSPF)1-9950
4LOSS(SIDE1)Surface image loss quantity set1-53
5LOSS(SIDE2)Back image loss quantity set1-53
6REARLOS(SIDE1)Surface rear edge image loss quantity set1-53
7REARLOS(SIDE2)Back rear edge image loss quantity set1-53

50-8

The adjustments on the machine side must have been normally completed.
PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX lead edge adjustment (read)
SectionFAX

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the lead edge adjustment with the 10 key.
  3. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

  1. Select the scanning method.

Even when the SPF/RSPF is selected, if there is no original on the SPF/RSPF, the OC is scanned.

Even when the OC is selected, if there is any original on the SPF/RSPF, the SPF/RSPF is scanned. (Setting 2)

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2SCAN SELECT (OC/ SPF/RSPF)Scan selection (1: OC, 2: SPF, 3: RSPF back)1-31
3LEADScan lead edge position adjustment value of the selected method in 2.43-5750
4LEFTScan left edge position adjustment value of the selected method in 2.43-5750
5REARScan rear edge position adjustment value of the selected method in 2.43-5750
6RIGHTScan right edge position adjustment value of the selected method in 2.43-5750

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

50-9

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)FAX lead edge adjustment (print)
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.

  1. Select an item to be adjusted.
  2. Enter the set value of the lead edge adjustment with the 10 key.

  3. Press the [START] key.

Normal displayNOW PRINTING
Error displayDOOR OPEN
JAM
PAPER EMPTY

There is no tray selection operation.

The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.

When two pages are scanned, duplex print is made,

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1COPY STARTCopy start--
2LEADPrint lead edge void adjustment value (Front surface)43-5753
3LEFTPrint left edge void adjustment value (Front surface)43-5753
4REARPrint rear edge void adjustment value (Front surface)43-5753
5LEAD (DUPLEX)Print lead edge void adjustment value (Back surface)43-5753
6LEFT (DUPLEX)Print left edge void adjustment value (Back surface)43-5753
7REAR (DUPLEX)Print rear edge void adjustment value (Back surface)43-5753

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

50-10

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the print image center position. (Adjustment can be made for each paper feed section.)
SectionImage processing (ICU)
ItemPicture qualityImage position

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key. The display goes to the copy menu.

When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying state and print is started.

(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1BYPASSManual paper feed1-9950
2TRAY11st tray
3TRAY22nd tray
4TRAY33rd tray
5TRAY44th tray
6DUPLEXBack print

50-12

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the print image center position. (Adjustment can be made for each document mode.)
SectionImage processing
ItemPicture qualityImage position

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.. The display goes to the copy menu.
    When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying state and print is started.

(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)

  1. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
    Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key.
    Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1OCOC document scan1-9950
2SPF(SIDE1)RSPF document front surface scan
3SPF(SIDE2)RSPF document back surface scan

51

51-1

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON time.
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
ItemSetting rangeDefault
1145mm/s1-9950
2122mm/s

51-2

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto the resist roller in each section (copier paper feed section, duplex paper feed section, RSPF paper feed section). (When the print image position varies greatly for the paper or when a lot of paper jam troubles occur, the adjustment is required.)
SectionPaper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Press the [START] key.
    The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
    Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.

  4. Press the [START] key.

Copying is started.

Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the initial menu, but the machine is not reset.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1BYPASSManual feed1-9950
2TRAY11st tray1-9950
3TRAY22nd tray1-9950
4TRAY33rd tray1-9950
5TRAY44th tray1-9950
6DUPLEXBack print1-9970
7SPF(SIDE1)RSPF front surface1-9950
8SPF(SIDE2)RSPF back surface1-9950

51-8

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl operation inhibit. (ON/OFF)
SectionImage process (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the set value with the 10-key.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
0ONEnable0-10
1OFFDisable

51-9

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage ON/OFF timing.
SectionProcess (OPC drum, developing, transfer, cleaning)
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1SHV ONSeparation voltage ON timing * Transfer V2ON reference (Synchronized with the adjustment value of 50.)25-9050
2SHV OFFSeparation voltage OFF timing * Transfer V2OFF reference (Synchronized with the adjustment value of 50.)50-9075

53-6

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the detection level of the RSPF width. The adjustment method is the 4-point system. Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position, and Min. position for adjustment.
SectionRSPF

Operation/Procedure

(Max. position setting)

  1. Set the guide to the maximum position, and press the [START] key.
  2. Set A4R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
  3. Set A5R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
  4. Set the guide to the minimum position, and press the [START] key.
  5. Set the paper recognition width (+), and press the [START] key.
  6. Set the paper recognition width (-) , and press the [START] key.

If "FAILED" is displayed in the above procedure 1, 2, 3, or 4, repeat the adjustment.

(Middle position L/S setting)

Middle position adjustment LYESMID-L ADJ.ON
NOMID-L ADJ.OFF
Middle position adjustment SYESMID-S ADJ.ON
NOMID-S ADJ.OFF

53-7

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to enter the RSPF width detection adjustment value.
SectionRSPF

Operation/Procedure

  1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
    The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
  2. Enter the RSPF original tray size adjustment value (specified on the back of the RSPF) with the 10-key.
ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
1MAX POSITIONMax. width0-9990
2POSITION 1Adjustment point 1
3POSITION 2Adjustment point 2
4MIN POSITIONMin. width

53-8

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the RSPF scan position of the mirror unit automatically. For the RSPF scan position automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is shifted to 11mm before the RSPF glass cover edge, and is operated automatically to scan images by the unit of 1 step, detecting the position up to the glass cover automatically.

Operation/Procedure

With the RSPF or the OC cover open, put a white paper on the OC glass (the RSPF glass surface is included for the RSPF standard model), and press the [START] key.

If the adjustment is executed normally, the adjustment value is displayed and saved in the EEPROM. If an error occurs, "ERR" is displayed and the value is not saved in the EEPROM.

If the adjustment is not performed because of abnormality, "---" is displayed.

During execution of the adjustment, the operation cannot be interrupted.

53-9

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)RSPF read position adjustment

Operation/Procedure

Press [START] key.

ItemSetting rangeDefault
Read position adjustment1-9950

53-10

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)RSPF exp adjustment

Operation/Procedure

  1. Press [START] key.
  2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
ItemSetting rangeDefault
1SPF EXPOSURE1-9953
2RSPF EXPOSURE

55-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the soft switch.
SectionOperation

Operation/Procedure

Used to enter the number of SW to be changed.

The bit to be changed is specified by 10-key. (The current value is highlighted.)

When [START] key is pressed, the entered value is set.

61-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation. Check speed can select 145mm/s or 122mm/s individually.
SectionLSU
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Press the [START] key, and the LSU test is performed.

Used to set the LSU to ON state and check that the sync signal (HSYNC/) is outputted or not.

After operation for 30 sec, the result is displayed. (Interruption cannot be made for 5 sec after starting the operation.)

63

63-1

PurposeAdjustment/setting/operation data output/check (display/print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the result of shading correction. (The shading correction data are displayed.)
SectionScanner (Exposure)
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Pressing the [START] key performs shading, and displays the result (center pixel).

63-7

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the RSPF white correction start pixel position automatically. This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is replaced.
SectionScanner
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Lift the RSPF unit to the fully open position, and press the [START] key.
[ ] indicates the order number of the pixel of the white sheet for RSPF exposure correction in the RSPF position.

If the adjustment is normally completed, "COMPLETE" is displayed and data are written into the EEPROM.

In case of an abnormality, "ERROR" is displayed and no data is written into the EEPROM.

The RSPF white correction start pixel = Displayed pixel position - 34 If the simulation is executed with the RSPF unit closed, an error will result.

64

64-1

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to check the operation of the printer function (auto print operation).
SectionPrinter
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the print item with the 10-key.
  2. Press the [START] key. The display is shifted to the copy menu.
  3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
  4. Press the [START] key. Copying is started.

During execution of the print test, the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key and the [INTERRU] key are invalid.

ItemContentSetting rangeDefault
12 BY 4 MODESelf print is made in 2 by 4 mode (printing 2 lines and not printing 4 lines). Since scanning is not performed, when the original is set on the RSPF, this cannot be performed. * Duplex print cannot be made.1-21
2LATTICE PRINTLattice print (1cm, 1dot width WLT, A3 print (A3 main scan, WLT sub scan)) is performed. * Duplex print can be made.
  • If the IMC board is not installed, the key inputs cannot be made.

65

65-1

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display section) detection position.
SectionOperation (Display, Operation)

Operation/Procedure

Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.

Adjust the touch panel coordinates.

When the point of "+" on the LCD is pressed, it turns gray. Press all the four points of +.

65-2

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Operation data output check (Display, Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the touch panel (LCD display section) detection position adjustment result.
SectionOperation (Display, Operation)

Operation/Procedure

Check the touch panel coordinates.

Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.

When the touch panel is pressed, the X-coordinate and the Y-coordinate (dot conversion values) are displayed.

65-5

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Operation data output check (Display, Print)
Function (Purpose)Used to check the key inputs of the operation panel.
SectionOperation (screen/operation)

Operation/procedure

Check the key input of the operation panel.

Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.

After completion of all key entries, "COMPLETE" is displayed.

66

66-1

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to change and check the FAX-related soft SW.
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the soft SW number to be selected with the 10-key.
  2. Check and change the setting content of the selected soft SW.
  3. Press the [START] key to save the set content.

The FAX-related soft SW is displayed on the LCD, and changing can be made by monitoring it.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-2

PurposeAdjustment
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW. (Except for the FAX adjustment values)
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

  1. Enter the country code with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
  2. When "1: (YES)" is selected, the soft SW corresponding to the country code is cleared. When "2: (NO)" is selected, the simulation is canceled.

Country code

Japan :00000000
U.S.A. : 10110101
Australia : 00001001
U.K. : 10110100
France : 00111101
Germany : 00000100
Sweden : 10100101
New Zealand:01111110
China : 00100110
Singapore : 10011100
Taiwan :11111110
India : 01010011
Malaysia : 01101100
Hong Kong : 01010000
Middle east : 11111101
SouthAfrica : 10011111
Spain : 10100000
Portugal : 10001011
Russia : 10111000
Denmark :00110001
Norway : 10000010
Switzerland : 10100110
Italy : 01011001
Belgium : 00001111
Luxembourg:01101001
Netherlands:01111011
Finland : 00111100

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-3

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)FAX PWB memory check
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Press the [START] key.

Read/write can be checked for FAX PWB memory.

The check result is displayed separately for each memory.

  1. Memory to be checked
DRAM
SRAM
Flash ROMProgram areaSUM check only
Memory area
Option memoryThe memory size follows the automatically detected value.
PAGE
MODEM
  1. Detailed procedure
1“55H” is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the address data are read in sequence to check that they were properly written.
2“AAH” is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the address data are read in sequence to check that they were properly written.
3“00H” is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the address data are read in sequence to check that they were properly written.
4Perform checks 1 - 3 sequentially. If there is no abnormality, it is “OK.” If there is any abnormality, “NG” is notified to the error address.
5The check result is saved. New result is overwritten with each check.

Interruption cannot be made during operation.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-4

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The signal is sent to the line and the machine speaker. (Sending the signal is continued until the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed.)

By entering the signal number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.

ItemSend signal
1NO SIGNALSignal not sent
233.6 V3433.6 V34
331.2 V3431.2 V34
428.8 V3428.8 V34
526.4 V3426.4 V34
624.0 V3424.0 V34
721.6 V3421.6 V34
819.2 V3419.2 V34
916.8 V3416.8 V34
1014.4 V3414.4 V34
1112.0 V3412.0 V34
129.6 V349.6 V34
137.2 V347.2 V34
144.8 V344.8 V34
152.4 V342.4 V34
1614.4 V3314.4 V33
1712.0 V3312.0 V33
1814.4 V1714.4 V17
1912.0 V1712.0 V17
209.6 V179.6 V17
217.2 V177.2 V17
229.6 V299.6 V29
237.2 V297.2 V29
244.8 V27t4.8 V27t
252.4 V27t2.4 V27t
260.3 FLG7EH Flag signal
27CED2100Tone signal
28CNG1100
290.3 V21
30ANSam
31RINGERPseudo-ringer sound ([ON HOOK] key ON)
32No MSGVoice message (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back tone can be sent to the line, keep the sound composition IC volume to 0.
33No RBTRing back tone (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back tone can be sent to the line, keep the G/A volume to 0.
34DP MAKEDial pulse (make)
Maintain the make state with keeping the condition to be able to send to the dial pulse line.
35DP BRKDial pulse (break)
Maintain the break state with keeping the condition to be able to send to the dial pulse line.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

Signal numberSend signal
32No MSGVoice message (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back tone can be sent to the line, keep the sound composition IC volume to 0.
33No RBTRing back tone (no sound)
Under the state where the ring back tone can be sent to the line, keep the G/A volume to 0.
34DP MAKEDial pulse (make)
Maintain the make state with keeping the condition to be able to send to the dial pulse line.
35DP BRKDial pulse (break)
Maintain the break state with keeping the condition to be able to send to the dial pulse line.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-5

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Signal send mode (Signal send level soft SW setting)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

By setting the signal number, signals are sent to the line and the machine speaker. (Sending signals is continued until interruption command is made (by pressing [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key.)

By entering the signal number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.

Signal numberSend signal
1NO SIGNALSignal not sent
233.6 V3433.6 V34
331.2 V3431.2 V34
428.8 V3428.8 V34
526.4 V3426.4 V34
624.0 V3424.0 V34
721.6 V3421.6 V34
819.2 V3419.2 V34
916.8 V3416.8 V34
1014.4 V3414.4 V34
1112.0 V3412.0 V34
129.6 V349.6 V34
137.2 V347.2 V34
144.8 V344.8 V34
152.4 V342.4 V34
1614.4 V3314.4 V33
1712.0 V3312.0 V33
1814.4 V1714.4 V17
1912.0 V1712.0 V17
209.6 V179.6 V17
217.2 V177.2 V17
229.6 V299.6 V29
237.2 V297.2 V29
244.8 V27t4.8 V27t
252.4 V27t2.4 V27t
260.3 FLG7EH Flag signal
27CED2100Tone signal
28CNG1100
290.3 V21
30ANSam
31RINGERPseudo-ringer sound ([ON HOOK] key ON)

66-6

PurposeData output, check
Function (Purpose)Printing the confidential password
SectionFAX
ItemDataConfidential/Pass code

Operation/procedure

Press the [START] key.

The confidential ID table (confidential BOX numbers, confidential BOX names, and confidential password) is printed.

The confidential data of My company mode is printed separately.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-7

PurposeData output, check
Function (Purpose)Print the screen memory contents
SectionFAX
ItemDataImage data

Operation/procedure

Press the [START] key.

Used to input all image data (including confidential reception data, remote send image, not-sent image) stored in image memory of the FAX section.

The output image is remained even after outputting.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-10

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Check
Function (Purpose)Image data memory clear
SectionFAX
ItemDataImage data

Operation/procedure

Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

Used to clear all image data (including confidential reception data) stored in image memory of the FAX section.

The management table is also cleared (initialized) at the same time.

  • If there is any print data, the power must be turned off after clearing.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-11

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level: Max.)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the interruption command is provided by pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key.)

The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set value.

The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execution of the mode after completion of the mode.

By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.

Item
1NO SIGNAL
211111
311110
400000
5010101
600001

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-12

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to send 300bps signals. (Signal send level: Set by soft SW)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the interruption command is provided by pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key.)

The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set value.

The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execution of the mode after completion of the mode.

By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execution, the signal kind can be changed.

Item
1NO SIGNAL
211111
311110
400000
5010101
600001

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-13

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to register the dial numbers.
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the number with the 10-key, [+] key, and [#] key.

Press the [CLEAR] key to return to the initial state.

Press the [START] key to register the entered number.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-14

PurposeOperation check/test
Function (Purpose)Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

  1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

  2. Set the make time with the 10-key.

The dial is sent with the set value +26ms

The sending dial cannot be interrupted.

ItemContentSetting range
0EXECUTEExecution-
1MAKE TIMEDial pulse make time setting0-15

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-15

PurposeOperation check/test
Function (Purpose)Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

  1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.

  2. Set the make time with the 10-key.

The dial is sent with the set value +9ms

The sending dial cannot be interrupted.

ItemContentSetting range
0EXECUTEExecution-
1MAKE TIMEDial pulse make time setting0-15

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-16

PurposeOperation check/test
Function (Purpose)Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send test)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

  1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
  2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.

The sending dial cannot be interrupted.

ItemContentSetting range
0EXECUTEExecution-
1HIGH (SW)High group0-15
2HIGH-LOW (SW)High group, Low group0-15
  1. Select the soft SW reflection.
ItemContent
1NO STORE TO SWNot reflected.
2STORE TO SWReflected. (Shift SW value changed.)

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-17

PurposeOperation check/test
Function (Purpose)Used to check the DTFM signal send operation. (Signal send level: Max.)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START] key. When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the simulation is terminated.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-18

PurposeOperation check/test
Function (Purpose)Used to check the DTFM signal send operation. (Signal send level: Set by soft SW.)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START] key. When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the simulation is terminated.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-19

PurposeBack up
Function (Purpose)Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
SectionFAX
ItemData

Operation/Procedure

Select "1: YES" with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The data are backed up. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

  • The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is executed, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data cannot be used in the AR-FX5.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-20

PurposeBack up
Function (Purpose)Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM.
SectionFAX
ItemData

Operation/Procedure

Select "1: YES" with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The Flash ROM data are read out and written into the SRAM. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

  • The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is executed, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data cannot be used in the AR-FX5.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-21

PurposeCheck
Function (Purpose)FAX information print
SectionFAX
ItemData

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the item to be printed.
  2. Press the [START] key.

The information of the selected item is printed.

ItemContent
1USER SW.LISTUser setting list
2SOFT SW.LISTSoft SW list
3SYSTEM ERRORSystem error list Used to print the system error log (error number and time).
4PROTOCOLProtocol error list Regardless of soft SW38-1 status, the protocol monitor of the preceding communication is printed. (Printing is allowed at any time before starting the next communication.) For this operation, the protocol monitor of one communication is always buffered.
5PARTIAL SRAM CLEARClear the FSS area in the SRAM.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-22

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

  1. Select the sound volume to be set.

(MAX: Large, MIDDLE: Medium, MIN: Small)

  1. Press [START] key.

Selection of 1, 2, and 3 can be made even during execution of the simulation.

A sound is generated during execution of the simulation.

Note: Execution is possible only when FAX is installed.

66-24

PurposeData clear
Function (Purpose)Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
SectionFAX
ItemDataInitializing

Operation/procedure

Select "1: YES" with the 10-key and press the [START] key. The FAST storage data are cleared. (When "2: NO" is selected, the simulation is canceled.)

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-30

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Used to set the TEL/LIU.
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

When the relay state of the polarity reverse relay, the handset hook switch, or the external telephone hook switch is changed, the content of change is displayed regardless of the soft SW setup (real time). The display of change is kept until an interruption command is supplied by pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key.

ItemNotification contents
Signal lowSignal high
HS2ONOFF
HS1ONOFF
RHSONOFF
EXHSONOFF

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-31

PurposeSetting
Function (Purpose)Used to set the TEL/LIU.
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

  1. Enter the set value. (Valid only 1 to 5)
  2. The entered bit is alternatively switched between "0" and "1" and the target signal name is highlighted.
  3. Press the [START] key to send the signal.

When the [CUSTUM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the output is terminated.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-32

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Receive data check
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The fixed data received from the line are checked and the result is displayed.

When data are coincident, "OK" is displayed. When not, "NG" is displayed.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-33

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Signal detection check
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/Procedure

Signal detection is checked and the result is displayed.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-34

PurposeOperation test/check
Function (Purpose)Communication time measurement display
SectionFAX
ItemOperation

Operation/procedure

The send/receive test is performed, and the time required for send/ receive of the image data in the test is measured and displayed.

Setup on the user side when executing communicationCommunication: Memory send means: Normal Character Picture quality: Lighter Density: ON ECM: OFF Sender information:
Measuring rangeSendFrom flag reception before sending of image data until sending of RCP frame
ReceiveFrom flag reception before reception of image data until reception of RCP frame
Mode when measuringUsed to make communication not in a simulation process but in the normal screen and measure the time.
How to check the timeEnter the simulation for communication time check and check the time.
Measuring unitmsec

When there are two or more send/receive operations of image data in one communication, only the time of the last send/receive data near the end is measured.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-37

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Check
Function (Purpose)Speaker sound volume adjustment
SectionFAX

Operation/procedure

The following test sound is delivered to the line and the speaker to adjust the sound kind and volume.

The send level to the line is the set value of soft SW.

The set values of the selected sound kind and volume are written to each soft SW.

  1. Sound kinds pattern
Sound kinds (Test sound)Sound volume set value
RINGERCall soundDEF.LAR.MED.SMA.
LINE MONITOLine monitor sound (Test sound: communication signal sound)DEF.LAR.MED.SMA.
ON HOOKOn-hook (Test sound, communication signal sound)DEF.LAR.MED.SMA.
SCAN FINISHScan finish soundDEF.LAR.MED.SMA.
TX/RX FINISHCommunication finish soundDEF.LAR.MED.SMA.
DTMFDTFM send soundDEF.LAR.MED.SMA.

LAR: (MED. Value + 1)

MED: (SMA value +1) - (LAR value - 1)

SMA: 1 - (MED. Value + 1)

  1. Sound volume pattern

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-41

PurposeAdjustment/Setting/Check
Function (Purpose)CI signal check

Operation/procedure

When the [START] key is pressed, the call signal from CI pin is detected to deliver the call sound to the line and the speaker. The volume of call sound follows the soft SW.

Signal detection and delivery of pseudo-call sound at detection are executed until the interruption command is provided by pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key.

Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.

66-52

PurposeOperation test/check (Japan only)
SectionFAX
ItemOperation
Function (Purpose)Pseudo-ringer check

Operation/procedure

Press [START] key.

The call sound of the machine and the pseudo-ring are generated.

[7] SELF DIAG AND TROUBLE CODE

  1. Trouble code list
Trouble codeTrouble contentsTrouble detection
Main codeSub code
A001Security incompatibility error
E100IMC PWB communication troubleMCU
10IMC PWB trouble
11IMC PWB ASIC error
12IMC PWB CODEC IC error
13IMC PWB flash ROM error
14IMC PWB expanded memory module (DIMM) error
15IMC PWB page memory error /SRAM error
16IMC PWB standard compression memory error
17IMC PWB smoothing IC error
80IMC PWB communication trouble (protocol)
81IMC PWB communication trouble (Parity)
82IMC PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
84IMC PWB communication trouble (Framing)
88IMC PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
E702LSU trouble
10CCD black level error
11CCD white level error
12Shading trouble
F100Finisher communication troubleFIN
03Delivery roller lift motor trouble
10Staple motor trouble
15Tray lift motor trouble
19Paper alignment motor F trouble
20Paper alignment motor R trouble
37RAM data trouble
50Incompatible trouble
95Paper exit option configuration error
F202Toner supply failure
04Model error
Type error
Destination error
Data abnormality
Misc error
05CRUM chip communication error
F502Copy lamp (xenon lamp) error
F600FAX control PWB communication troubleMCU
10FAX control PWB trouble
80FAX control PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
81FAX control PWB communication trouble (Parity)
82FAX control PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
84FAX control PWB communication trouble (Framing)
88FAX control PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
96Combination error between the MCU and the FAX firmware.
99FAX control PWB destination error
F900Printer PWB communication troubleMCU
10Printer PWB trouble
Trouble codeTrouble contentsTrouble detection
Main codeSub code
F980Printer PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
81Printer PWB communication trouble (Parity)
82Printer PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
84Printer PWB communication trouble (Framing)
88Printer PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
H200Main heater lamp thermistor open hard detection
01Sub heater lamp thermistor open hard detection
H300Main heater lamp abnormally high temperature hard detection trouble
01Sub heater lamp abnormally high temperature hard detection trouble
10Main heater lamp abnormally high temperature soft detection trouble
11Sub heater lamp abnormally high temperature soft detection trouble
H400Main heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
01Sub heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
20Main heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
21Sub heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
H50110 times of continuous detection of the lower paper exit sensor (POD1) lead edge jam or the upper paper exit sensor (POD2) lead edge jam or the duplex sensor (PPD2) rear edge jam
L100Scanner feed trouble
L300Scanner return trouble
L401Main motor trouble
11Shifter motor trouble
31VFM trouble
32DCFM or DCFM2 trouble
33VFM2 trouble
L610Polygon motor trouble
L810Power abnormality detection trouble
U101FAX battery error
02PANEL LOW battery error
U204EEPROM communication error
20Machine speed code data error
U700RIC communication trouble
U900Operation control PWB communication troubleOPE
80Operation control PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
81Operation control PWB communication trouble (Parity)
82Operation control PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
84Operation control PWB communication trouble (Framing)
88Operation control PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
99Operation panel destination error
EEELDeveloper adjustment trouble (Over-toned abnormality)
EUDeveloper adjustment trouble (Under-toned abnormality)
PF00PF trouble
  1. Details of trouble code
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
A001ContentSecurity incompatibility error
DetailsWhen the PCL or the FAX control PWB is installed, it does not match with compatible/incompatible setup of the MCU PWB security.
CauseThe security compatibility/incompatibility of the installed PCL or FAX control PWB does not match with that of the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheek the security compatibility/incompatibility of each board. Match the security compatibility/incompatibility of the boards.
E100ContentIMC PWB communication trouble
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and IMC PWB
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
10ContentIMC PWB trouble
DetailsIMC PWB hardware abnormality
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
11ContentIMC PWB ASIC error
DetailsASIC abnormality on IMC PWB
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
12ContentIMC PWB CODEC IC error
DetailsCODEC IC (JBIG chip) abnormality on IMC PWB
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
E113ContentIMC PWB flash ROM error
DetailsFlash ROM abnormality on IMC PWB
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB. When the program download is abnormally terminated, a error may occur. In this case, download the program again.
RemarksProgram ROM abnormality
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
E114ContentIMC PWB expanded memory module (DIMM) error
DetailsIMC extended compression memory module (DIMM) installation error. IMC extended compression memory module (DIMM) access error.
CauseIMC expanded memory module installation trouble. IMC expanded memory module trouble. IMC expanded memory contact trouble. IMC PWB abnormality.
Check and remedyCheck installation of the expanded memory module. (Spec: Added to Slot 1.) Replace the expanded memory module. Replace the IMC PWB.
RemarksExtend memory abnormality for compressed image store (DIMM module)
15ContentIMC PWB page memory error /SRAM error
DetailsIMC PWB page memory or work SRAM access error
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
RemarksPrint buffer page memory or work SRAM abnormality
16ContentIMC PWB standard compression memory error
DetailsAccess error of standard compression memory on IMC PWB
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
RemarksStandard compression image store memory abnormality
17ContentIMC PWB smoothing IC error
DetailsIMC PWB smoothing IC abnormality
CauseIMC PWB abnormality
Check and remedyReplace the IMC PWB
80ContentIMC PWB communication trouble (protocol)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and IMC PWB (Protocol error)
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
81ContentIMC PWB communication trouble (Parity)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer IMC (Parity error)
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
E182ContentIMC PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and IMC PWB (Overrun error)
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
84ContentIMC PWB communication trouble (Framing)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and IMC PWB (Framing error)
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
88ContentIMC PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and IMC PWB (Time-out error)
CauseIMC PWB connector disconnection. Motherboard connector pin breakage. IMC PWB ROM defect, data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors of the IMC PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check the ROM of the IMC PWB.
E702ContentLSU trouble
DetailsBD signal from LSU is not detected in a constant cycle (Kept OFF or ON)
CauseLSU connector or LSU inside harness trouble or disconnection. Polygon motor rotation abnormality. Laser does not illuminate. MCU PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck for disconnection of the LSU connector. Check the LSU operation with SIM 61-1. Check that the polygon motor rotates normally. Check laser LED lighting. Replace the LSU unit. Replace the MCU PWB.
10ContentCCD black level error
DetailsCCD black reference plate scan level abnormality when the copy lamp turns off.
CauseFlat cable installation failure to CCD unit. CCD unit error.
Check and remedyCheck flat cable installation to the CCD unit. Check CCD unit.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
E711ContentCCD white level error
DetailsImproper CCD white reference plate reading level for copy lamp lighting
CauseFlat cable installation failure to CCD unit. Dirt on the mirror, lens, and reference white plate. Copy lamp lighting trouble. CCD unit abnormality. MCU PWB abnormality. (Occurred in the RSPF scan position)
Check and remedyClean the mirror, the lens, and the reference white plate. Check the copy lamp light quantity and its operation. (SIM 5-3) Check CCD unit. Check MCU PWB.
12ContentShading trouble
DetailsWhite correction is not completed in the specified number of times.
CauseFlat cable installation failure to CCD unit. Dirt on the mirror, lens, and reference. white plate. Copy lamp lighting trouble. CCD unit abnormality. MCU PWB abnormality.
Check and remedyClean the mirror, the lens, and the reference white plate. Check the copy lamp light quantity and its operation. (SIM 5-3) Check CCD unit. Check MCU PWB.
F100ContentFinisher communication trouble
DetailsCommunication line test error occurs when power is turned on or after the exit of a simulation mode. Error in finisher communication
CauseConnection trouble or disconnection of the connector and harness between the body and the finisher. Finisher control PWB trouble. Control PWB failure. Malfunction by noises.
Check and remedyCanceled by turning OFF/ON the power. Check the connectors and the harness of communication line. Replace the finisher control PWB.
03ContentDelivery roller lift motor trouble
DetailsPaper exit roller lift-up motor operation abnormality
CauseMotor lock. Motor rpm abnormality. Overcurrent to the motor. Finisher control PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM3-3 to check the delivery roller lift motor operation
10ContentStaple motor trouble
DetailsStaple motor operation abnormality
CauseMotor lock. Motor rpm abnormality. Overcurrent to the motor. Finisher control PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM 3-3 to check the staple motor operation.
F115ContentTray lift motor trouble
DetailsThe finisher lift-up motor does not reach the specified position
CauseLift-up motor abnormality.Lift-up motor upper limit sensor abnormality.Finisher PWB abnormality.
Check and remedyUse SIM 3-3 to check the lift-up motor operation
19ContentPaper alignment motor F trouble
DetailsAlignment motor operation abnormality
CauseMotor lock.Motor rpm abnormality.Overcurrent to the motor.Finisher control PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM3-3 to check the alignment (F) motor operation.
20ContentPaper alignment motor R trouble
DetailsAlignment motor operation abnormality
CauseMotor lock.Motor rpm abnormality.Overcurrent to the motor.Finisher control PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM3-3 to check the alignment (R) motor operation
37ContentRAM data trouble
DetailsBackup RAM contents are disturbed
CauseFinisher control PWB trouble.Malfunction by noise.
Check and remedyReplace the finisher control PWB.
50ContentIncompatible trouble
DetailsSpeed does not coincide between finisher and main unitA finisher which is not applicable is installed.
CauseConnection of a finisher incompatible with the machine is detected.
Check and remedyConnect the MX-FN13 to the machine.
95ContentPaper exit option configuration error
DetailsAn improper option is installed.
CauseConfiguration of the paper exit option is improperness.
Check and remedyInstall a proper option.
F202ContentToner supply failure
DetailsThe value judged from the actual toner supply hysteresis differs greatly from the toner sensor value
CauseDeveloping unit trouble.Toner supply abnormality caused by installation of unpacked toner cartridge.
Check and remedyReplace the developing unit.Use SIM 25-1 to perform DV stirring.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
F204ContentModel error
Type error
Destination error
Data abnormality
Misc error
Details(Model error)When the boot program model code does not match with the CRUM model information
(Type error)When the CRUM type is other than [Genuine/Conversion/Production rotation]
(Destination error)The destination of the body differs from that of the CRUM
(Data abnormality)The initial check information includes an erroneous value.When the max. toner supply time is 00.When the print hard stop is 00.
CauseCRUM chip failure.Erroneous TNCA.
Check and remedyReplace the CRUM chip.Replace the TNCA.
05ContentCRUM chip communication error
CauseCRUM chip failure.Developing unit contact trouble.MCU PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck installation of the developing unit.Replace the MCU PWB.
F502ContentCopy lamp (xenon lamp) error
DetailsThe copy lamp does not light up
CauseCopy lamp abnormality.Copy lamp harness abnormality.CCD PWB harness abnormality.
Check and remedyCheck the copy lamp. (SIM 5-3)When the lamp lights:Check the harnesses and connectors between the CCD unit and the MCU PWB.When the lamp does not light:Check the harness and connector between the copy lamp and the MCU PWB.Replace the copy lamp unit.Replace the MCU PWB.
F600ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection.Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB.Motherboard connector pin breakage.FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB Check the grounding of the copier.Check FAX control PWB ROM.
10ContentFAX control PWB trouble
DetailsFAX control PWB abnormality
CauseFAX control PWB defect
Check and remedyReplate the FAX control PWB
F680ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB (Protocol error)
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check FAX control PWB ROM.
81ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble (Parity)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB (Parity error)
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check FAX control PWB ROM.
82ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB (Overrun error)
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check FAX control PWB ROM.
84ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble (Framing)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB (Framing error)
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check FAX control PWB ROM.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
F688ContentFAX control PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and FAX control PWB (Time-out error)
CauseFAX control PWB connector disconnection.Harness trouble between FAX control PWB and MCU PWB.Motherboard connector pin breakage.FAX control PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of FAX control PWB and MCU PWB.Check the grounding of the copier.Check FAX control PWB ROM.
96ContentCombination error between the MCU and the FAX firmware.
DetailsThe version of the FAX firmware is not changed “04.xx” or later.
CauseThe version of the FAX firmware is not proper.
Check and remedyChange the version of the FAX firmware to “04.xx” or later.
99ContentFAX control PWB destination error
DetailsThe machine destination setup does not coincide with the FAX control PWB destination setup.
CauseThe machine destination setup (Sim 26-6) does not coincide with the FAX control PWB setup
Check and remedyCheck the variety of FAX LIU PWB.Check the machine destination setup (Sim 22-6) and FAX country code (Soft SW table).
F900ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection.Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB.Motherboard connector pin breakage.Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB.Check the grounding of the copier.Check ROM on printer PWB.
10ContentPrinter PWB trouble
DetailsPrinter PWB abnormality
CausePrinter PWB defect
Check and remedyReplace the printer PWB
80ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB (Protocol error)
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection.Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB.Motherboard connector pin breakage.Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB.Check the grounding of the copier.Check ROM on printer PWB.
F981ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble (Parity)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB (Parity error)
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check ROM on printer PWB.
82ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB (Overrun error)
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check ROM on printer PWB.
84ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble (Framing)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB (Framing error)
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check ROM on printer PWB.
88ContentPrinter PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and printer PWB (Time-out error)
CausePrinter PWB connector disconnection. Harness trouble between the printer PWB and the MCU PWB. Motherboard connector pin breakage. Printer PWB ROM defect/Data failure.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the printer PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check ROM on printer PWB.
H200ContentMain heater lamp thermistor open hard detection
DetailsMain heater lamp thermistor open detection. Fusing unit not installed.
CauseMain thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure. Fusing unit not installed.
Check and remedyCheck the harness and the connector of the thermistor and the MCU.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
H201ContentSub heater lamp thermistor open hard detection
DetailsFusing sub thermistor open detection. Fusing unit not installed.
CauseSub thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure. Fusing unit not installed.
Check and remedyCheck the harness and the connector of the thermistor and the MCU.
H300ContentMain heater lamp abnormally high temperature hard detection trouble
DetailsThe fusing main heater thermistor causes abnormally high temperature
CauseMain thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure.
Check and remedyCheck the main heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-1. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.
01ContentSub heater lamp abnormally high temperature hard detection trouble
DetailsThe fusing sub thermistor causes abnormally high temperature
CauseSub thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure.
Check and remedyCheck the sub heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-2. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.
10ContentMain heater lamp abnormally high temperature soft detection trouble
DetailsA/D value the fusing main thermistor causes abnormally high temperature (over 230°C).
CauseMain heater lamp thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure.
Check and remedyCheck the main heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-1. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14. In case of a problem with SIM 14, check the source of the fault.
H311ContentSub heater lamp abnormally high temperature soft detection trouble
DetailsA/D value the fusing sub heater lamp thermistor causes abnormally high temperature (over 230°C).
CauseSub heater lamp thermistor defect. Control PWB failure. Fusing section connector contact failure.
Check and remedyCheck the sub heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-2. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.
H400ContentMain heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
DetailsThe setup temperature (about 90°C) is not reached within the specified time (about 20sec) from turning on the power. When the temperature of main heater lamp thermistor falls below 140°C in the standby mode or printing. When the temperature of main heater lamp thermistor falls below 50°C in the pre-heat mode.
CauseMain heater lamp thermistor defect Main heater lamp failure Main thermostat failure Control PWB failure
Check and remedyCheck the heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check for disconnection of the heater lamp and thermostat. Check the interlock switch. Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
H401ContentSub heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
DetailsThe setup temperature (about 90°C) is not reached within the specified time (about 20sec) from turning on the power. When the temperature of sub heater thermistor falls below 140°C in the standby mode or printing. When the temperature of sub heater lamp thermistor falls below 50°C in the pre-heat mode.
CauseSub heater lamp thermistor defect. Sub heater lamp failure. Sub thermostat failure. Control PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck the sub heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-2. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.
20ContentMain heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
DetailsThe setup temperature (about -25°C: Sim 43-1-1) is not reached within the specified time (about 40sec) from turning on the power. A/D value of fusing main thermistor is not reached within the specified temperature. (specified temperature : SIM43-1 (600dpi) -25°C)
CauseMain thermistor defect. Main heater lamp failure. Main thermostat failure. Control PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck the main heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-1. When the lamp blinks normally: Check the thermistor and the harness. Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit. If lamp lights and stays lit: Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB. Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14. Check that there is no foreign material in the contact section between the thermistor and the heat roller.
H421ContentSub heater lamp abnormally low temperature detection
DetailsThe setup temperature (about -25°C: Sim 43-1-1) is not reached within the specified time (about 40sec) from turning on the power.A/D value of fusing sub thermistor is not reached within the specified temperature (specified temperature : SIM43-1 (600dpi) -25°C )
CauseSub thermistor defect.Sub heater lamp failure.Sub thermostat failure.Control PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck the sub heater lamp blinking with SIM 5-2-2.When the lamp blinks normally:Check the thermistor and the harness.Check the MCU PWB thermistor input circuit.If lamp lights and stays lit:Check the power circuit and the lamp control circuit on MCU PWB.Clear the display of self-diagnostics with SIM 14.Check that there is no foreign material in the contact section between the thermistor and the heat roller.
H501Content10 times of continuous detection of the lower paper exit sensor (POD1) lead edge jam or the upper paper exit sensor (POD2) lead edge jam or the duplex sensor (PPD2) rear edge jam
DetailsAfter supplying the power, one of the above jams occurs 10 times continuously in printing Counting is started on supplying the power. When any one of the above jams occurs, one count is made. When paper entry to the POD1 or POD2 is detected, the counter is cleared.
CauseA paper jam (paper rounding, etc.) near the duplex sensor (PPD2) on the fusing unit is not canceled completely.POD1, POD2, PPD2 sensor breakdown or harness connection troubleFusing unit installation failure
Check and remedyCheck for jam paper in the fusing section.(paper winding, etc.)Check fusing unit installation Check the POD1, POD2 or PPD2 sensor. Clear the trouble with SIM 14.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
L100ContentScanner feed trouble
DetailsScanner feed is not completed within the specified time.
CauseMirror unit defect. Scanner wire disconnection. Origin detection sensor error. Mirror motor harness abnormality.
Check and remedyCheck the scanning operation with SIM 1-1. When the mirror not feeds: Check for disconnection of the scanner wire. Check the harness and connector between the mirror motor and the MCU PWB. Replace the mirror unit. Replace the MCU PWB. When the mirror feeds: Check the mirror home position sensor with SiM 1-2.
L300ContentScanner return trouble
DetailsScanner return is not completed within the specified time. When OC copying with the mirror at the home position, the mirror is not in the home position.
CauseMirror unit defect. The scanner wire is disconnected. Origin detection sensor error. Mirror motor harness abnormality.
Check and remedyCheck the scanning operation with SIM 1-1. When the mirror fails to return: Check for disconnection of the scanner wire. Check the harness and connector between the mirror motor and the MCU PWB. Replace the mirror unit. Replace the MCU PWB. When the mirror feeds: Check the mirror home position sensor with SiM 1-2.
L401ContentMain motor trouble
DetailsThe main motor does not rotate. The motor lock signal is detected for 1sec or more after the main motor rotates. The motor lock signal is detected for 1sec during rotation of the main motor.
CauseMain motor defect. Main motor connection, harness trouble or disconnection. MCU PWB failure.
Check and remedyCheck the main motor operation with SIM 25-1. Check connection of the main motor harness and connector. Replace the main motor. Replace the MCU PWB.
L411ContentShifter motor trouble
DetailsThe shifter home position detection signal is not detected when the shifter is operating.
CauseShifter motor trouble or harness connection trouble and disconnection.Shifter home position sensor trouble.
Check and remedyCheck the shifter motor operation with SIM 3-11.Check connection of the shifter motor harness/connector.Replace the shifter motor.Replace the MCU PWB.
31ContentVFM fan trouble
Details5 sec after starting the fan motor rotation, the motor lock signal is detected for 1 sec.During rotation of the fan motor, the motor lock signal is detected for 1 sec.
CauseFan motor trouble.Fan motor connection harness connection trouble or disconnection.MCU PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM6-2 to check the operation of the fan motor.Check connection of the fan motor harness and connector.Replace the fan motor.Replace the MCU PWB.
32ContentDCFM or DCFM2 fan trouble
Details5 sec after starting the fan motor rotation, the motor lock signal is detected for 1 sec.During rotation of the fan motor, the motor lock signal detected for 1 sec.
CauseFan motor trouble.Fan motor connection harness connection trouble or disconnection.MCU PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM6-2 to check the operation of the fan motor.Check connection of the fan motor harness and connector.Replace the fan motor.Replace the MCU PWB.
33ContentVFM2 fan trouble
Details5 sec after starting the fan motor rotation, the motor lock signal is detected for 1 sec.During rotation of the fan motor, the motor lock signal detected for 1 sec.
CauseFan motor trouble.Fan motor connection harness connection trouble or disconnection.MCU PWB trouble.
Check and remedyUse SIM6-2 to check the operation of the fan motor.Check connection ofthe fan motor harness and connector.Replace the fan motor.Replace the MCU PWB.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
L610ContentPolygon motor lock trouble
DetailsThe polygon motor does not rotate. The motor lock signal is detected for 18sec or more after the polygon motor rotates. The motor lock signal is detected for 1sec during rotation of the polygon motor.
CausePolygon motor unit failure Polygon motor connection, harness trouble or disconnection MCU PWB failure
Check and remedyCheck the polygon motor operation with SIM 61-1. Check the connectors and the harness of polygon motor Replace the polygon motor. Replace the MCU PWB.
L810ContentPower abnormality detection trouble
DetailsThe power status monitoring signal keeps power OFF state after passing the specified time (2sec).
CauseCircuit around the power status monitoring signal (PSSTS) failure.
Check and remedyCheck whether power status monitoring signal (PSSTS) on MCU PWB is OPEN or not. Replace MCU PWB.
U101ContentFAX battery error
DetailsThe SRAM backup battery voltage on FAX control PWB falls.
CauseThe SRAM backup battery voltage on FAX control PWB falls.
Check and remedyCheck voltage of the SRAM back up battery. Replace the battery.
02ContentPANEL LOW battery error
DetailsThe voltage of the panel clock function battery falls.
CauseThe voltage of the panel clock function battery falls.
Check and remedyCheck voltage of panel clock function battery. Replace the battery.
U204ContentEEPROM communication error
DetailsEEPROM communication error
CauseEEPROM defect. ICU PWB EEPROM access circuit failure.
Check and remedyCheck that the EEPROM is properly set. Clear trouble with SIM 16. Replace the MCU PWB.
20ContentMachine speed code data error
DetailsThe machine boot speed information is not identical to the model code speed information
CauseEEPROM defect. SIM operation error.
Check and remedyCheck for matching of the machine and model information setting in SIM26-57.
U700ContentRIC communication trouble
DetailsError in communication with RIC. Error in communication test after turning on the power or canceling SIM.
CauseConnector harness contact trouble or disconnection. RIC control PWB trouble. MCU PWB failure. Malfunction by noises.
Check and remedyCheck the communication cable, connectors from the RIC box to the main body.
U900ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation control PWB
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection. Harness failure of the operation control PWB and the MCU PWB
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier. Check ROM on the operation control PWB.
80ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble (Protocol)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation control PWB (Protocol error)
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection. Harness failure of the operation control. PWB and the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier.
81ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble (Parity)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation control PWB (Parity error)
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection. Harness failure of the operation control PWB and the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier.
82ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble (Overrun)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation control PWB (Overrun error)
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection. Harness failure of the operation control PWB and the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier.
Trouble codeDetails of trouble
Main codeSub code
U984ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble (Framing)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation control PWB (Framing error)
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection.Harness failure of the operation control PWB and the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier.
88ContentOperation control PWB communication trouble (Time-out)
DetailsCommunication trouble between MCU and the operation PWB (Time-out error)
CauseOperation control PWB connector disconnection.Harness failure of the operation control PWB and the MCU PWB.
Check and remedyCheck the connectors and the harness of the operation control PWB and MCU PWB. Check the grounding of the copier.
99ContentOperation panel destination error
DetailsAn error occurred in checking the destination of the operation panel and the main body.
CauseErroneous connection the operation panel unit.SIM setup error.
Check and remedyCheck the destination information of the operation panel unit and the MCU.(Sim26-6/22)
EEELContentDeveloper adjustment trouble (Over-toned abnormality)
DetailsAn abnormality occurred in execution of automatic developer adjustment.Sample data was detected over-toner.
CauseToner concentration sensor abnormality.Toner concentration trouble.Developing unit trouble.MCU PWB failure.
Check and remedyUse SIM 25-2 to perform the auto developer adjustment.
EUContentDeveloper adjustment trouble (Under-toned abnormality)
DetailsAn abnormality occurred in execution of automatic developer adjustment.Sample data was detected under-toner.
CauseToner concentration sensor abnormality.Toner concentration trouble.Developing unit trouble.MCU PWB failure.
Check and remedyUse SIM 25-2 to perform the auto developer adjustment.
PF00ContentPF trouble
DetailsThe copy inhibit command from RIC is received.
CauseJudged by the host.
Check and remedyInform to the host.

[8] MAINTENANCE

1. Maintenance list (For 26cpm)

X: Check (Check, clean, replace or adjust according to necessity.)

O: Cleaning ▲: Replace ☆: Lubricate

UnitParts75k150k225k300k375k450k525k600kNote
ProcessDrum
Cleaner blade
Seal F/R××××××××
Drum frame unit(Toner reception sheet)××××××Usable for three PM cycles
MC unit
Separation pawl unit××××
Star ring
DVDeveloper
Toner filter unit
DV blade××××
DV side sheet F××××
DV side sheet R××××
Toner sensor××××××××
FusingUpper heat roller
Lower heat roller
Upper separation pawl
Upper cleaning pad××××
Lower separation pawl
Thermistor
Fuser gear
Upper heat roller bearing××××
Lower fuser bearing××××××
Thermistor cleaning pad××××
Paper guide
Paper feedPickup roller××××××××Changing criteria for parts: 100k
Paper feeding sheet××××××××
Pickup roller and feed roller(RSPF)××××××××
TransportTransport roller unit
Gear×-×-×-×-
OthersPaper feed rollers
Gears
Ozone filter

(For 31cpm)

X: Check (Check, clean, replace or adjust according to necessity.)
O: Cleaning ▲: Replace ☆: Lubricate

UnitParts100k150k200k300k400k450k500k600kNote
ProcessDrum××
Cleaner blade××
Seal F/R××××××××
Drum frame unit(Toner reception sheet)××××××Usable for three PM cycles
MC unit××
Separation pawl unit××××
Star ring
DVDeveloper××
Toner filter unit××
DV blade××××
DV side sheet F××××
DV side sheet R××××
Toner sensor×-×××-××
FusingUpper heat roller
Lower heat roller
Upper separation pawl
Upper cleaning pad××××
Lower separation pawl
Thermistor
Fuser gear
Upper heat roller bearing××××
Lower fuser bearing××××××
Thermistor cleaning pad××××
Paper guide
Paper feedPickup roller××××××××Changing criteria for parts: 100k
Paper feeding sheet××××××××
Pickup roller and feed roller(RSPF)××××××××
TransportTransport roller unit
Gear×-×-×-×-
OthersPaper feed rollers
Gears
Ozone filter

2. Details of Maintenance

UnitParts
A. Process unit(1)Drum
(2)Drum sectiona.Main charger
b.Cleaning blade
c.Drum frame unit
d.Moquette F/R
e.Separation pawl
B. Developing unit(1)Developer
(2)Toner filter unit
(3)DV side sheet F/ DV side sheet R
(4)DV blade
(5)Toner sensor
C. Fusing section(1)Thermostat
(2)Thermistor
(3)Paper guide
(4)Fusing separation pawl (lower)
(5)Lower heat roller
(6)Heater lamp
(7)Upper cleaning pad
(8)Fusing separation pawl (upper)
(9)Upper heat roller
(10)Thermistor cleaning pad
D. Optical section(1)CCD unit
(2)Lamp unita.Lamp
b.PWB
c.Wire
d.Mirror motor
E. Paper feed section(1)Paper feed solenoid
(2)Tray sensor PWB
(3)Manual P-in sensor/Manual empty sensor
(4)Multi manual paper feeda.Paper feed roller/pickup roller
b.Reverse sensor
c.Separation sheet
d.Clutch/solenoid
(5)Upper 500 sheets tray paper feeda.Paper feed roller/pickup roller
b.Separation sheet
(6)Lower 500 sheets tray paper feeda.Paper feed roller/pickup roller
b.Separation sheet
c.Lift up unit
d.Transport clutch
e.Paper feed clutch
f.Transport clutch
g.Solenoid
h.Sensor PWB
F. Side door unit(1)Transport roller unit
(2)Transport roller
(3)DUP transport roller
(4)DUP motor
G. 1st paper exit unit(1)Cooling fan
(2)Transport/exit roller
H. Laser unit(1)LSU
I. Power unit(1)Power source
J. PWB(1)Option CN PWB
(2)IMC PWB
(3)MCU PWB
(4)Motherboard PWB
(5)Second interface PWB
K. Ozone filter
UnitParts
L. Drive section(1)DUP reverse motor
(2)Main drive motor
(3)Toner motor
(4)PS transport clutch
(5)Paper feed clutch
(6)Drive unit
(7)Lift up motor
M. Transport section(1)Transport roller
N. Operation section(1)Operation section
(2)OPU PWB
(3)Key PWB
(4)LCD unit
O. Switch(1)Power switch
P. RSPF(1)Document tray sectiona.Document tray unit
b.Document length sensor
c.Document width resistor PWB
(2)Paper feed unit sectiona.Paper feed clutch
b.Pickup roller
c.Paper feed roller
d.Paper feed unit
e.Separation sheet
f.Sensor
(3)Transport sectiona.Transport unit
b.PS clutch
c.Pressure release solenoid
d.RSPF motor
e.Transport roller
f.Roller
g.Sensor
h.Roller
i.Roller
(4)Base sectiona.Interface PWB
b.Solenoid
c.Book sensor
d.Sensor

A. Process unit

(Note for servicing the OPC drums)

1. Prevention of oily dirt attachment

Note:

  • Be careful not to attach fingerprints or oily dirt on the OPC drum surface. (Keep the unit away from oils and dust.)
  • When replacing the OPC drum, cover the OPC drum with the protection sheet and hold the protection sheet.

If it is required to hold the OPC drum directly, use enough care not to touch the cleaning blade area, 5mm inside from both edges of the OPC drum. (If a fingerprint or oily dirt is attached to the cleaning blade area of the OPC drum, the cleaning blade may flip.)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Prevention of oily dirt attachment - 1

[Countermeasures]

If a fingerprint is attached to the OPC drum surface erroneously, perform the following countermeasures.

1) Use dry cloth to clean and remove the dirt.
2) Apply KYNAR to prevent blade flip.

[Check method]

Check to confirm that the OPC drum is free from fingerprints or oily dirt and that the cleaning blade is completely cleaned by the following method.

  • Make a print of a half tone image on all the surface of A4 (11" x 8.5") paper, and check the printed paper for any abnormality in the image.

2. Prior exposure prevention

Note:

  • Avoid servicing in a place where there is strong light.
  • Do not expose the unit to light for a long time.
  • Cover the OPC drum with light-blocking material. (When using paper, use about 10 sheets of paper to block light.)

[Countermeasures]

If the OPC drum is erroneously exposed to light too much (prior exposure), perform the following countermeasures.

1) Print half tone images on the whole surface of A4 (11" x 8.5") paper, and check to confirm that there is no irregular density area in the previously exposed section.
2) Damages due to prior exposure may be recovered by keeping the OPC drum for several hours. If, however, image are not recovered, replace the OPC drum.

(1) Drum

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drum - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Drum - 2
Note: When installing the process unit in the main unit after replacing the drum, process unit may not be able to install by reason of the drum drive coupling position. In this case, rotate the drum about 45 degrees and install again.

(2) Drum section

a. Main charger

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - a. Main charger - 1

b. Cleaning blade

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - b. Cleaning blade - 1

c. Drum frame unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - c. Drum frame unit - 1

d. Moquette F/R
SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - c. Drum frame unit - 2
Note: If it disturbs the blade movement, replace it and attach new one.

e. Separation pawl

Disassembly* Hold the tip of the separation pawl and remove it.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - e. Separation pawl - 1
Assembly* Press the center of the separation pawl and install it.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - e. Separation pawl - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - e. Separation pawl - 3

B. Developing section

(1) Developer
SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing section - 1
Rotate the MG roller to discharge developer.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing section - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Developing section - 3

(2) Toner filter unit

With the guide AS (cover) removed, replace it.

When replacing, clean the guide AS.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner filter unit - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner filter unit - 2
(3) DV side sheet F/ DV side sheet R
[DV side sheet F/ DV side sheet R attachment reference]

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner filter unit - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner filter unit - 4
(4) DV blade

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner filter unit - 5
[DV blade attachment reference]

(5) Toner sensor

  • Execution of cleaning the sensor must be made after discharging used DV in DV replacement.
  • Without removing the MG roller, use waste cloth to remove toner from the sensor surface in the arrow direction.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 1

  • Clean the sensor only after removing used DV when replacing DV.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 2
C. Fusing section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 4
(1) Thermostat
Note: When securing the lamp harness and the thermostat, the tightening torque of the screw (4 positions) is 6-9 kgs.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 5
(2) Thermistor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 6
(3) Paper guide

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 7
(4) Fusing separation pawl (lower)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 8
(5) Lower heat roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 9

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 10
(6) Heater lamp

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 11
(7) Upper cleaning pad

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 12
(8) Fusing separation pawl (upper)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 13

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 14
(9) Upper heat roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 15

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Toner sensor - 16
(10) Thermistor cleaning pad

D. Optical section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 1
(1) CCD unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 3
(2) Lamp unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 4

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 5
a. Lamp

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 6

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 7
b.PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 8
c. Wire

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 9

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 10
d. Mirror motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 11
E. Paper feed section

APaper feed roller
BPickup roller
CSeparation sheet

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 12
(1) Paper feed solenoid

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 13
(2) Tray sensor PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 14
(3) Manual P-in sensor/Manual empty sensor
(4) Multi manual paper feed

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 15
a. Paper feed roller/pickup roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 16
Installation*Install so that the cam transmit arm (1) comes under the roller arm (2).

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 17
b. Reverse sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 18

c. Separation sheet
SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 19
* Slightly apply grease GP501MR (UKOG-0012QSZZ) around the axis. One rice grain for each.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 20
d. Clutch/solenoid
(Clutch)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 21
(Solenoid)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 22
(Clutch)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 23

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 24

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 25
(5) Upper 500 sheets tray paper feed
a. Paper feed roller/pickup roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 26

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 27

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 28
Note: With the toner cartridge installed, do not tilt or shake the developer cartridge.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 29

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 30

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 31
* When replacing, be careful not to adhere conduction grease (black) to the drive section.
Slightly apply grease GE676 (UKOG-0013QSZZ) to the drum boss.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 32

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 33
b. Separation sheet

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 34

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 35

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 36

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 37

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Optical section - 38
* Slightly apply grease GP501MR (UKOG-0012QSZZ) around the axis. One rice grain for each. Grease should not come out when assembling.

(6) Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed

a. Paper feed roller/pickup roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 3
b. Separation sheet

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 4

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 5
* Slightly apply grease GP501MR (UKOG-0012QSZZ) around the axis. One rice grain for each. Grease should not come out when assembling.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 6
c. Lift up unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 7
d. Transport clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 8
e. Paper feed clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 9
f. Transport clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 10
g. Solenoid

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 11

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lower 500 sheets tray paper feed - 12
h. Sensor PWB

F. Side door unit

(1) Transport roller unit
SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 1
* Check that two springs are securely inserted into the transfer roller unit bosses.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 2
(2) Transport roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 4

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 5

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 6
(3) DUP transport roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 7

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 8
(4) DUP motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 9
G. 1st paper exit unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 10
(1) Cooling fan

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 11

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 12
(2) Transport/exit roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 13

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 14

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 15

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 16

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 17

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 18

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 19

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 20

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 21
Note: Check to confirm that the solenoid shaft is in the gate bracket, and fix with the screw.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 22

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Side door unit - 23

H. Laser unit

Note: Do not disassemble the LSU unit.

(1) Lsu

1) Turn OFF the machine power, and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet.
2) Remove the left cabinet and exit tray.
3) Disconnect the LSU connector, and remove the securing screws to remove the LSU.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lsu - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lsu - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lsu - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Lsu - 4

I. Power unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Power unit - 1
(1) Power source

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Power unit - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Power unit - 3

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Power unit - 4

J. PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 1
(1) Option CN PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 2

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 3
(2) IMC PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 4
(3)MCUPWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 5

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 6
(4) Motherboard PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 7

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 8

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 9
(5) Second interface PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 10

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 11

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 12

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 13

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 14

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 15
K. Ozone filter

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 16

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 17

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 18
L. Drive section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 19
(1) DUP reverse motor
(2) Main drive motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 20

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 21
(3) Toner motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 22
(4) PS transport clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 23

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 24
(5) Paper feed clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 25
(6) Drive unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 26
Drive unit (Grease application part)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 27
(7) Lift up motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 28
M. Transport section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 29
(1) Transport roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 30

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 31

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 32
N. Operation section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 33
(1) Operation section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 34

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 35
(2) OPU PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 36
(3) Key PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 37

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 38
(4) LCD unit
O. Switch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 39
(1) Power switch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 40

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 41

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 42
P. RSPF
(1) Document tray section
a. Document tray unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 43

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 44

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 45
b. Document length sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 46
(2) Paper feed unit section
a. Paper feed clutch
b. Pickup roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 47

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 48

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 49
c. Document width resistor PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 50

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 51
c. Paper feed roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 52

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 53

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 54
d. Paper feed unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 55

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 56
e. Separation sheet

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 57
f. Sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 58
b. PS clutch

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 59

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 60
c. Pressure release solenoid

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 61
(3) Transport section
a. Transport unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 62

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 63
d. RSPF motor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 64

The motor is positioned by the jig. Use the mark when assembling it to the original position.

e. Transport roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 65

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 66

f. Roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 67

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 68

g. Sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 69

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 70

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 71
h. Roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 72

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 73
i. Roller

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 74

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 75
(4) Base section
a. Interface PWB
b. Solenoid

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 76

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 77
c. Book sensor

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 78

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 79

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - PWB - 80

A. Counter clear

ItemSIMRemarks
Maintenance cycle settingSIM 21-1
Jam/trouble counter clearSIM 24-1
Paper feed counter clearSIM 24-2
Scan/Stapler counter clearSIM 24-3
Maintenance counter clearSIM 24-4*
Developing counter clearSIM 24-5After execution of SIM25-2, this counter is cleared.
Copy counter clearSIM 24-6
Drum counter clearSIM 24-7At drum replacement
Printer, IMC, Duplex, other counter clearSIM 24-9
FAX counter clearSIM 24-10
Scanner mode counter clearSIM 24-15
  • 31 sheet model: When maintenance message is displayed, replace consumption part reaching the number of sheets of maintenance, then clear the replaced part's counter only.

[9] FIMWARE UPDATE

1. Firmware update procedure

(Necessary items for update)

A Personal computer
B RS232C cross cable (D-sub 9pin to D-sub 9pin, or D-sub 25pin to D-sub 9pin)
C Software for version-up

(Target PWB)

1MCUPWB
2 Panel PWB
3 IMC PWB
4 Finisher PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - (Target PWB) - 1
Outline of Update Procedure

Prepare following files necessary for program update

  • Maintenance software: maintenance.exe
  • Andromeda module file: ProcModelR.mdl
  • Maintenance tool driver: SFZEJENU.inf

A. Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm)

Following operational procedures are for:

  • Copier firm
    fax firm

1) Make sure copier is off, and connect it to PC with download cable beforehand.
2) Start up the maintenance program on PC. Select the model name from the model selection dialogue box.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 1

3) Make sure only "Printer Control Board" tree is visible under "Simulation Command List".

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 2

4) Turn on the copier. The machine starts up in the download mode.
5) Additional tree will be visible when downloading maintenance program on PC.
* Make sure to start up maintenance program before turn on the machine.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 3

6) When downloading copier firm, expand "Special(Copier)", and double-click on "All Data areas Download".

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 4

7) Select download file(.dat), and press "Open" button.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 5

8) Download procedure starts automatically.

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Firmware update method (for Copier, and fax firm) - 6

9) Notice message "Download is complete. Check the copier panel to make sure the download is complete." will appear on PC.
10) Close the maintenance program, and turn off the copier. Turn on the copier again after pulling the plug.

This is the end of download procedure.

  • It is possible that download process somehow went wrong if the copier does not start up properly. In that case, start up the copier and maintenance program in download mode by repeating the step 1)-5) again. And then, Expand "Special", and double-click on "Confirm Error Status". If any of the message besides "No error has been occurred" appears, it means that download is incomplete, so please try again.

B. Others (Troubleshooting)

Followings are the error possibly occur during the download process and troubleshooting method.

NoWarning/errormessageDetail
1Incorrect destination. Continue with the download process?Destination of download file and copier doesn't match.Possible to select either continue or cancel the job.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]To change destination, select "Yes". If not, select "No" and cancel download process.
2Incorrect download file.Invalid download file for the machine is selected, or the file format is not correct.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
3No downloadable data included.Unable to find appropriate data in selected download file.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
4This option not available.Download procedure is executed on uninstalled optional kit.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Confirm installed optional kit.Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.
5The data size exceeds the Flash ROM size.Try again with the appropriate size of data.Panel flash ROM size is not enough to execute download procedure.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Confirm the download file. Possibly the improper download file is selected.Exchange the flash ROM to the one which has more capacity.
6Time out error.Transmission errorUnable to receive data from the machine among the certain period of time.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Restart maintenance program after confirming communication port or communication cable.
7Communication (incoming) error.Incorrect download procedure.The machine did not proceed download procedure correctly.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Restart maintenance program after confirming communication port or communication cable.Make sure the communication device of PC(either COM or parallel) is under right condition.
8Checksum error.Transmission errorThe check sum value of the transmission data is mismatch.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Restart maintenance program after confirming communication device of PC (either COM or parallel) is under right condition.
9Error during the download process. Error code: 0xXXXXXXXXXDownload data file operation error.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Restart maintenance program after confirming the selected download file is not abnormal andnot using other application.
10An error. [0xXXXXXXXXX]The error occurred except the above errors.
[TROUBLESHOOTING]Restart maintenance program after confirming communication device of PC(either COM orparallel) is under right condition.

[10] ELECTRICAL SECTION

1. Block diagram

A. SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM - 1

2. Actual wiring chart

A. MCU - Panel unit, Optical base plate sensor section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 1

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 2
B. MCU - Optical base plate 2, OP I/F PWB, 1st paper exit unit, 2nd paper exit unit

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 3
C. Manual feed, 1st tray unit section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 4
D. 2nd tray unit section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 5
E. Fusing unit, Power supply unit section

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 6

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 7
SPCL PWB

Board to Board Connector

MOTHER PWB

10 27 34 5 6 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80

Board to Board Connector

FAX PWB FAX PWB

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - Actual wiring chart - 8

  1. Signal list
Signal nameNameFunction/OperationConnector levelConnector No.Pin No.PWB nameNOTE
“L”“H”
CLCopy lampControls ON/OFF of the copy lamp.ONOFFCN263MCU
CLHRSPF clutchControls ON/OFF of the RSPF paper feed roller.ONOFFCN513RSPF interface
COVERRSPF cover open/close detectionDetects open/close of the RSPF cover.OPENCLOSECN52RSPF interface
CSS1Tray 1 installation detectionDetects installation of tray 1.NOYESCN1522MCU
CSS2Tray 2 installation detectionDetects installation of tray 2.NOYESCN71Standard tray I/F
CSS3Tray 3 installation detectionDetects installation of tray 3.NOYESCN71Option tray I/F
CSS4Tray 4 installation detectionDetects installation of tray 4.NOYESCN48Option tray I/F
DPXDuplex motorControls the duplex motor.--CN12,3,4,5MCU
DRS2Door open/close detection (Tray 2)Detects door open/close.OPENCLOSECN85Standard tray I/F
DRS3Door open/close detection (Tray 3)Detects door open/close.OPENCLOSECN85Option tray I/F
DRS4Door open/close detection (Tray 4)Detects door open/close.OPENCLOSECN45Option tray I/F
DUP2SENDUP2 paper delivery sensorDetects paper delivery in the reverse path.YESNOCN1512MCU
EHUDHumidity sensorSenses the humidity.--CN5032MCUAnalog detection
ERTHTemperature sensorSenses the temperature.--CN5034MCUAnalog detection
GSOLGate solenoidReverses the paper exit gate in ON operation.ONOFFCN42RSPF interface
HLOUT1Heater lamp mainTurns ON/OFF the heater lamp main.OFFONCN1010MCU
HLOUT2Heater lamp subTurns ON/OFF the heater lamp sub.OFFONCN1012MCU
HPEMPTYManual feed paper presence detectionDetects presence of paper for manual paper feed.YESNOCN1516MCU
HPINManual feed paper entry detectionDetects paper entry for manual feed.NOYESCN1526MCU
HPSIZE1Manual feed paper length detectionDetects the length of manual feed paper.NOYESCN1517MCU
HPSIZE2Manual feed paper size detection (Longitudinal direction)Detects the size of manual feed paper. (longitudinal direction)NOYESCN1523MCU
HPSOLManual paper feed solenoidControls the manual paper feed solenoid.ONOFFCN157MCU
HPTRAY1Manual paper feed tray length detectionDetects the length of manual feed tray paper.LONGSHORTCN159MCU
HPTRAY2Manual paper feed tray length detectionDetects the length of manual feed tray paper.SHORTLONGCN1513MCU
HPWSManual feed paper width detectionDetects the width of manual feed paper.--CN1531MCU
KEEPPSOLRight paper exit gate solenoidDrives the right paper exit gate solenoid.ONOFFCN178,9MCU
LUD1HLift-up motor upper limit detectionDetects the upper limit of the lift-up motor.Not detectedDetectedCN148MCU
LUD2Lift-up motor upper limit detection (Tray 2)Detects the upper limit of the lift-up motor.Not detectedDetectedCN86Standard tray I/F
LUD3Lift-up motor upper limit detection (Tray 3)Detects the upper limit of the lift-up motor.Not detectedDetectedCN86Option tray I/F
LUD4Lift-up motor upper limit detection (Tray 4)Detects the upper limit of the lift-up motor.Not detectedDetectedCN46Option tray I/F
LUM1HLift-up motorDrives the lift plate of the paper tray.OFFONCN156MCU
"L""H"
LUM2DLift-up motorDrives the lift plate of the paper tray.OFFONCN11Standard tray I/F
LUM3DLift-up motorDrives the lift plate of the paper tray.OFFONCN11Option tray I/F
LUM4DLift-up motorDrives the lift plate of the paper tray.OFFONCN414Option tray I/F
MHPMirror home position sensorCorrects the initial position of the scanner.Other than home position.Home positionCN2333MCU
MIRMODMirror motorControls the mirror operation.--CN9061,2,3,4OP I/F PWB
MMDMain motorControls the main motor.ONOFFIC2153MCU
MMRDYMain motor lockDetects lock of the main motor.RotationLockIC2152MCU
OCCOVEROC cover open/close detectionDetects open/close of the OC cover.OPENCLOSECN2329MCU
OZNFANOUTOzone fanControls the ozone fan.OFFONCN50210MCU
PAP1HPaper pass sensor (Tray 1)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN146MCU
PAP2Paper pass sensor (Tray 2)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN84Standard tray I/F
PAP3Paper pass sensor (Tray 3)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN84Option tray I/F
PAP4Paper pass sensor (Tray 4)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN44Option tray I/F
PAPERPaper entry sensorDetects paper entry.YESNOCN518SPF interface
PCL1HPaper feed clutch (Tray 1)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN152MCU
PCL2Paper feed clutch (Tray 2)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN31Standard tray I/F
PCL3Paper feed clutch (Tray 3)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN31Option tray I/F
PCL4Paper feed clutch (Tray 4)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN410Option tray I/F
PCS1HPaper feed solenoid (Tray 1)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN142MCU
PCS2Paper feed solenoid (Tray 2)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN87Standard tray I/F
PCS3Paper feed solenoid (Tray 3)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN87Option tray I/F
PCS4Paper feed solenoid (Tray 4)Controls ON/OFF of the paper feed roller.ONOFFCN412Option tray I/F
PDPXDuplex sensorDetects paper presence for duplex.YESNOCN193MCU
PFULL2No. 2 paper exit full sensorDetects paper full in the No. 2 paper exit unit.YESNOCN215MCU
PFULL2_RRight paper exit full sensorDetects paper full in the right paper exit unit.YESNOCN175MCU
PGSOLPaper exit gate solenoidControls the paper exit gate.ONOFFCN222,3MCU
PINPaper entry sensorDetects paper entry.YESNOCN144MCU
POUT1No. 1 paper exit sensorDetects paper exit of the No. 1 paper exit unit.NOYESCN326MCU
POUT2No. 2 paper exit sensorDetects paper exit of the No. 2 paper exit unit.YESNOCN212MCU
POUT2_RRight paper exit sensorDetects paper exit of the right paper exit unit.YESNOCN172MCU
POUTCOVPaper exit cover open/close detectionDetects open/close of the paper exit cover.OPENCLOSECN2110MCU
POUTFANOUTPaper exit cooling fanCools the fusing unit.OFFONCN5043,6MCU
POUTFANRDYPaper exit cooling fan lock detectionDetects lock of the paper exit cooling fan.RotationLockCN5042,5MCU
PPD2Paper pass sensor (Tray 2)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN82Standard tray I/F
PPD3Paper pass sensor (Tray 3)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN82Option tray I/F
PPD4Paper pass sensor (Tray 4)Detects paper pass.YESNOCN42Option tray I/F
PREMSOLPaper separation solenoidControls the paper separation solenoid.ONOFFCN112MCU
PSFANOUTPS fanDrives the PS fan.OFFONCN293,6MCU
PSFANRDYPS fan lock detectionDetects lock of the PS fan.RotationLockCN292,5MCU
PSOLPS solenoidControls ON/OFF of the PS roller.ONOFFCN511SPF interface
PSRSOLResist roller solenoidControls the resist roller.ONOFFCN154MCU
RSOLReverse solenoidReverses the paper exit gate in ON operation.ONOFFCN515SPF interface PWB
RTH1Thermister 1Detects the fusing temperature.--CN194MCU
RTH2Thermister 2Detects the fusing temperature.--CN196MCU
SFTDShifter motorOffsets paper.--CN23,4,5,6MCU
SFTHPShifter home position sensorDetects the home position of the shifter.Other than home position.Home positionCN324MCU
SPFOPENSPF cover open/close sensorDetects open/close of the SPF cover.OPENCLOSECN524SPF interface
SPFOUTSPF paper exit sensorDetects paper exit of the SPF.YESNOCN31SPF interface
SPFWSSPF document width detectionDetects SFP documents.--CN29SPF interfaceAnalog detection
TFANOUTFusing fanDrives the fusing fan.OFFONCN3210,12MCU
TFANRDYFusing fan lock detectionDetects lock of the fusing fan.RotationLockCN3214,16MCU
TMDToner motorControls the toner motor.--CN31,2MCU
TONERToner sensorDetects the toner density.--CN5026MCUAnalog detection
TRCL2Vertical transport clutchControls ON/OFF of the vertical transport roller.ONOFFCN21Standard tray I/F
TRCL3Vertical transport clutchControls ON/OFF of the vertical transport clutch.ONOFFCN21Option tray I/F
W0Paper empty sensorDetects paper empty.YESNOCN51SPF interface

LEAD-FREE SOLDER

The PWB's of this model employs lead-free solder. The "LF" marks indicated on the PWB's and the Service Manual mean "Lead-Free" solder. The alphabet following the LF mark shows the kind of lead-free solder.

Example:

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - LEAD-FREE SOLDER - 1

Solder compositionSolder composition code
Sn-Ag-Cua
Sn-Ag-Bi Sn-Ag-Bi-Cub
Sn-Zn-Biz
Sn-In-Ag-Bii
Sn-Cu-Nin
Sn-Ag-Sbs
Bi-Sn-Ag-P Bi-Sn-Agp

(1) NOTE FOR THE USE OF LEAD-FREE SOLDER THREAD

When repairing a lead-free solder PWB, use lead-free solder thread.

Never use conventional lead solder thread, which may cause a breakdown or an accident.

Since the melting point of lead-free solder thread is about 40^ higher than that of conventional lead solder thread, the use of the exclusive-use soldering iron is recommendable.

(2) NOTE FOR SOLDERING WORK

Since the melting point of lead-free solder is about 220^ , which is about 40^ higher than that of conventional lead solder, and its soldering capacity is inferior to conventional one, it is apt to keep the soldering iron in contact with the PWB for longer time. This may cause land separation or may exceed the heat-resistive temperature of components. Use enough care to separate the soldering iron from the PWB when completion of soldering is confirmed.

Since lead-free solder includes a greater quantity of tin, the iron tip may corrode easily. Turn ON/OFF the soldering iron power frequently.

If different-kind solder remains on the soldering iron tip, it is melted together with lead-free solder. To avoid this, clean the soldering iron tip after completion of soldering work.

If the soldering iron tip is discolored black during soldering work, clean and file the tip with steel wool or a fine filer.

デジル複合機

Digital Multifunction System

MX-M260/N/FG/FP

MX-M310/N/FG/FP

AR-5726/5731

MX-VR10

(Except North America,

Japan, Argentina)

MX-RP10

(North America, Japan,

Argentina is standard)

MODEL MX-TR11

(Japan is standard)

  • Interchangeability of parts is expressed by No1~6 as shown in the table below.

1Interchangeable.
2Current type can be used in place of new type. New type cannot be used in place of current type.
3Current type cannot be used in place of new type. New type can be used in place of current type.
4Not interchangeable.
5Interchangeable if replaced with same types of related parts in use.
6Others.
  • New & Addition, Change, Abolition, and Quantity change are expressed with the marks shown in the table below.

New & AdditionN
Change
Abolition×
Q'quantity (increase) /Others
Q'quantity (decrease)
CorrectionC
  • Running Change of Effective Time is expressed as R/C.

R / CRunning Change

補修部品の兰ク付

Rank A : Maintenance parts, and consumable parts which are not included in but closely related to maintenance parts
Rank B : Performance/function parts (sensors, clutches, and other electrical parts), consumable parts
Rank E : Unit parts including PWB
Rank D: Preparation parts (External fitting, packing, parts packed together)
Rank C : Parts other than the above (excluding sub components of PWB)

Because parts marked with "▲" is indispensable for the machine safety maintenance and operation, it must be replaced with the parts specific to the product specification.

○当モデルのサイーニス資料には、その資料以外にサイーニスマニアル(回路図含む)のはろ。合わせて利用下載。
Other than this Parts Guide, please refer to documents Service Manual(including Circuit Diagram) of this model.
Please use the 13 digit code described in the right hand corner of front cover of the document, when you place an order.
For U.S. only-Use order codes provided in advertising literature. Do not order from parts department.

:定期交换的必要性:
: Maintenance parts for which the periodic replacement is necessary.

10 結紙部(Paper feed section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XEBS 7 30 P 1 0000ACDDCScrew(3×10)£'λ
2CPWBF 0 081 QSE2APEQECassette sensor PWB加さルリフ基板
3MLEVP 0 064 QSZZADDJCPaper detect actuator紙換知7円工-4
4MLEVP 0 063 QSZ1ADDJCUpper limit detect actuator上限核知刀工-4
5MLEVP 0 056 QSZZACDJCP-IN actuatorP-IN7円工-4
6MSPRD 0 201 QSZZACDJCPaper feed in actuator spring入紙7円工-4 空洞-4
7PCOVP 0 064 QSZZADDJDSolenoid coverルフローロ-4
8RPLU 0 026 QSZ1AREQBPaper feed solenoid絡紙ルフ-4
RPLU - 0 026 QSP 11AREQBPaper feed solenoid絡紙ルフ-4
9MARP 0 026 QSZZADDJCSolenoid armルフローロ-4
10NROLR 0 1 33 QSZZAMEGAPick up roller£' イフローロ-4
11MARP 0 019 QSZZADDJCPick up arm F£' イフローロ-4 F
13NGERH0 9 90 FCZZABDJCGear(16T)£' λ
14NROLR 0 1 32 QSZ1AREQCPaper feed roller AND2絡紙ローロ-AND2
15MARP 0 021 QSZZADDJCPick up arm R£' イフローロ-4 R
16LP i N - 0 026 MCZZAADDCSpring pin(φ2-8)£' イフローロ-4
17NGERH0 1 07 QSZZADDJCPaper feed gear(20T)絡紙ローロ-4
18MSPRD 0 389 QSZZACDJCPick up roller pressure spring£' イフローロ-4 加压スフ-4
19NBRGC0 1 00 FCZ1ACDJCBearing 6^ ナリス6
20NGERH0 0 97 QSZZAFDSC2nd joint gear2nd連結扌
21DHA i - 0 350 QSPZAGDXCCassette sensor harness加さルリフ-4
22QSW-B 0 017 QSZZAFDSBTray detect switch徒接知447
23NGERH0 1 56 QSZZADDJCPaper feed clutch gear(42T)絡紙ローロ-4
24MSPRC0 2 09 QSZ1ACDJCSolenoid springルフローロ-4
25XRESP 40 - 0 60 00AADDCE type ring(E4)E' ナリス
27XRESP 50 - 0 60 00AADDCE type ring(E5)E' ナリス
28PCLC - 0 024 QSZZAXFGBPaper feed clutch(42T)絡紙ローロ-4
29NSFT Z 0 080 QSZ1AGDSCPaper feed roller shaft絡紙ローロ-4 軸
30VHPSG2481 ++ -1AEDSBPhoto sensor(SG2481)打交道-4
31DHA i - 0 399 QSPZAFDSCManual paper feed empty harness手差L 工厂工-4 消音材 C
32XEBS T 30 P 0 80 00ACDDCScrew(3×8)£' λ
34LPLTP 0 1 92 QSZZAKDXCDehumidify heater fixing plate(Japan)除湿比-4 取付板
35RHT - 0 0 0 6 QSZZAQEQBDehumidify heater(Japan)除湿比-4
36PSHEZ 0 391 QSZ1ACDJCPaper feed solenoid sound proof A絡紙ルフ-4 消音材 A
37PSHEZ 0 392 QSZ1ABDJCPaper feed solenoid sound proof B絡紙ルフ-4 消音材 B
38PSHEZ 0 393 QSZ1AADJCPaper feed solenoid sound proof C絡紙ルフ-4 消音材 C
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 補修部品の兰ク付 - 1
10 結紙部(Paperfeedsection)

11 搬送部(Paper transfer section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XEBS740P12000AADDCScrew(4×12)b'λ
2PCOVP0053QSZ6AKEBDMiddle frame cover中間ル-あら"-
3MSPRD0194QSZ1ADDJCPS earth spring LPPS 7-λλ''Lp''LP
4MSPRC0291QSZZACDJCPS pressure springPS 加压λ''Lp''
5NSFTZ0065QSZ1ADDJCPS sub shaftPS 從動軸
6NKOM-0006QSZZACDJCPS collar(φ13.5)PS ハ
7PSHEZ0133QSZZADDJCPaper feed sheet鉛鉛用ト
8XEBS740P10000AADDCScrew(4×10)b'λ
9PG i DM0067QST1APEQCBase plate paper feed guide台板絵紙''ト''
10MSPRD0233QSZ1ACDJCMF actuator springMF 7''Lp''-λ''Lp''
11MLEVP0023QSZZAEDSCMF actuatorMF 7''Lp''-λ''Lp''
12MLEVP004QSZZAEDSCMF actuator 2MF 7''Lp''-2
13LPLTP0348QSZZACDJCSeparator plate挪きレト
14MSPRC0301QSZZADDJCPressure plate spring压着板λ''Lp''
15PFTA-0019QSZZAEDSDPressure plate cover压着板盖
16XEBS730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10)b'λ
17PSHEZ0242QSZ1AHDXCPressure plate sheet压着板ト
18LRALP0008QSZANEGCBase plate rail R台板レトR
19VHPGP1S73P+-18AFDSBPhoto sensor(GP1S73P)フローナー
20DHA i -0398QSPZAEDSCManual paper feed P-IN harness手差 L-P-IN-ス
21MSPRD0202QSZZABDJCManual paper feed P-IN actuator spring手差 L-P-IN-ス''Lp''-λ''Lp''
22MLEVP0057QSZZACDJCManual paper feed P-IN actuator手差 L-P-IN-ス''Lp''-λ''Lp''
23PSHEZ0515QSZZAGDXASeparator sheet挪きレト
24LPLTP0409QSZZACDJCSeparator plate AND2挪きアレトAND2
25PCOVP0088QSZ1ADDJDPlate cover7''Lp''-
26MSPRC0270QSZZABDJCSeparator plate spring挪きアレトλ''Lp''
27NKOM-0005QSZZACDJCCassette guide collar加さはト''ト''
28NSFTZ0048QSPZAFDSCCassette collar shaft加さはト・轴
29XBPS730P08KS0ABDDCScrew(3×8KS)b'λ
30PSHEZ0301QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet FレリR''Lp''-トF
31PSHEZ0302QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet RレリR''Lp''-トR
32PSHEZ0463QSZZADDJCFront separator sheet前摺きト
33PSPÖ-0026QSZZAADJCMF ACT cushionMF ACT λ''Lp''
34LHLDZ0094QSZZACDJCPS pressure holderPS 加压はト"
35MSPRC0292QSZZACDJCPS follower connect springPS 従勤接続λ''Lp''
36MSPRD0287QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller spring給紙補助ローナー"。
37NROLP0087QSZZADDJCPaper feed sub roller給紙補助ローナー"
38NSFTZ0101QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller shaft給紙補助ローナー"。
39PSHEZ0314QSZ2AFDSCToner protect sheet Nけ一飛散封止マリ-N
40LBRC-0012QSZZADDJCManual paper feed sub collar bracket手差 L辅助加7''Lp''ト
41NKOM-0011QSZZACDJCManual paper feed sub collar手差 L辅助加
42NSFTZ0101QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller shaft給紙補助ローナ・轴
43MSPRD03008000ACDDCSeparator guide plate挪きアレト
44XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
45LPLTP0396QSZ1ADDJCSeparator guide plate挪きアレト
46LX-WZ0064FCZZAADDCPush nut(M3)7''Lp''ト
47PG i DM0186QSZZAKDXDCover guide加''Lp''ト''
48LPLTP0622FCZZACDJCM4 plate NM4 7''Lp''N
49CG i DM0067RS56-AXFGEBase plate paper feed guide unit [Missing parts code]台板絵紙加"ト"。
50CCOVP0053RS55-ASEZEMiddle frame cover unit [Missing parts code]中間ル-ム加"ト"。
51CCOVP0088RS56-ANEQEPlate cover unit [Missing parts code]7''Lp''-1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.11.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1分離7''Lp''トト
52CCOVP0053RS55-ASEZEMiddle frame cover unit [Missing parts code]中間ル-ム加"ト"。
53CCOVP0088RS56-ANEQEPlate cover unit [Missing parts code]7''Lp''-1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.11.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.2.8 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.8 1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.1.8 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 補修部品の兰ク付 - 2
11 搬送部(Paper transfer section)

12 トトトト(Side door unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART MARKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1MLEVP0058QSTZ-ADDJCLock levertorlal" -
2GDOR-0002QSTD-AVFGDRight door [Missing parts code]右下?1st lot
3XRESP40-06000-AADDCE type ring(E4)E リル"
4LBSHZ0303FCZZ-ACDJCM bushing CM フリフNGC
5NGERH0074QSZZ-ADDJCDUP roller drive gearDUP ネーブーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニーニード
6LPINS0133FCZZ-AADDCPin(2×10)awful" -
7PMTE-0020QSZ1-ACDJCLock pawltori"
8MSPRD0222QSZZ-ACDJCLock pawl springtori"
9MARP0043QSZZ-ACDJCLock pawl armtori"
10NSFTZ0055QSZ3-AHDXCLock pawl shafttori"
11XRESP30-06000-AADDCE type ring(E3)E リル"
12NROLP0036QSZZ-APEQCDUP transport rollerDUP 搬送tori"
13XPSSJ20-07000-AADDCSpring pin (φ2-7)tori"
14MSPRT0279QSZ1-ACDJCDUP follower springDUP 從動tori"
15NROLP1122FCZZ-AFDSCPS upper rollerPS 上口-
16LFRM-0040QSZ3-ASEQDRight door inner(Except Japan) 右下"
LFRM-0040QSZ4-ASEQDRight door inner(Japan) 右下"
17MSPRC0349QSZZ-ADDJCHigh voltage spring B高压tori"
18MSPRC0348QSZZ-ADDJCHigh voltage spring A高压tori"
19LPLTM0102QSZZ-ADDJCDUP roller earth plateDUP α-7-7-7-7板
20LHLDZ0084QSZ1-AEDSCTR terminal interface holderTR 端子中縄はり"
21XEBS730P06000-AADDCScrew(3×6)b" -
22MSPRC0296QSZZ-AFDSCTR pressure spring RTR 压接tori"
23MSPRC0295QSZZ-AFDSCTR pressure spring FTR 压接tori"
24XHBS730P10000-ADDDCScrew(3×10)b" -
25XHBS730P16000-AADDCScrew(3×16)b" -
26XEBS730P10000-ACDDCScrew(3×10)b" -
27LPLTM0090QSZ1-AEDJCInner reinforce plate F内村一補強板F
29LPLTM0091QSZ1-AEDJCInner reinforce plate R内村一補強板R
30MSPRD0205QSZZ-AEDSCTC ground springTC イード"
31LRALP0004QSZ3-AHDXCRight door rail右下"
32LPLTM0363QSZZ-AFDSCRail reinforce plateレフ補強板
33CHLDZ0150RS52-BEGNATC unit (Except Japan) TC ビル"
CHLDZ0150RS51-BEGNATC unit (Japan) TC ビル"
34PSHEZ0307QSZ1-ABDJCRight door sheet右下"
35PSHEZ0431QSZ1-AFDSCRight door DUP sheet右下"
36LX-BZ0084QSPZ-ABDDCScrewb" -
37NGERH0243QSZZ-ADDJCTC gear(20T)TC ビル"
38XEBS730P08000-ACDDCScrew(3×8)b" -
39MSPRC0289QSZZ-ABDJCTC roller spring R REF軽写tori"
40MSPRC0280QSZZ-ACDJCTC roller spring F軽写tori"
41LSUPP0003QSZ1-ADDJCRight door roller rib右下"
42PCLR-0014QSZ1-ADDJCTC roller collar A2RTC ビ-らが-A2R
43PG i DH0093QSZ3-ANEGCTR front paper guideTR 前"
44LHLDZ0150QSZ1-AKDXCTransfer holder And2 Ref軽写はり"
45LPLTM0365QSZZ-ADDJCTR electrode plateTR 電極板
46NROLR0159QSZ1-AYFQCTransfer roller AN3軽写tori"
47NBRGP0023QSZZ-ADDJCRoller bearingtori"轴受
48LPLTM0245QSZ2-AGDXCTR reinforce plateTR 補強板
49LX-BZ1181FCZZ-ABDDCScrew(3×6K)b" -
50LPLTM0512QSZZ-AGDXCSeparate discharge sheet剥離電圧ト
51LPLTM0247QSZZ-ACDJCSeparate electrode plate剥離電極板
52PMLT-0044QSZZ-AADJCTR cushion [MX-M Series]TR ビル"
PMLT-0044QSZZ-AADJCTR cushion [MX-M Series]TR ビル"
53PSEL-0163QSZ1-AHDXCTransfer cleaner pad軽写tori"
54LHLDZ0151QSZZ-AFDSCSide door unit(Without No.33) [Japan] (Japan) [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan]
55PRNGF0107FCZ1-ACDJCStar ringtori"
(Unit)
901CDOR-0002RS62-BFGNESide door unit(Without No.33) [Except Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan ] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan] [Japan][No.]

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 補修部品の兰ク付 - 3

13 ルフ手差しト(Multi manual paper feed tray unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1PG i DM0 075QSTZ-AEDJCMB side guide F[Missing parts code] MB リフガリフ1st lot
2PG i DM0 076QSTZ-AEDJCMB side guide R[Missing parts code] MB リフガリフ R1st lot
3XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)t'λ
4LSOU-0024QSTEASEQDManual paper feed tray 1 upper手差レフ1上
5PTME-0271FCZZADDJCTray lock pawlレフ爪
6MSPRC0250QSZZACDJCTray lock springレフガリフ
7NGERR0140QSZZADDJCWidth detect rack幅検知りが
8XEPS730P06X00AADDCScrew(3×6X)t'λ
9NGERP1385FCZZAFDSCWidth detect pinion幅検知にご
10LHLDZ0066QSZZADDJCHarness holderハラスフフ-
11LSOU-0026QSTCAPEQDManual paper feed tray 2 upper手差レフ12上
12QSW-B0017QSZZAFDSBTray detect switchレフ検知りが
13DHA i-0359QSZZAPEQCManual paper feed unit harness手差レフハト-は
14MSPRP1385FCZZAADJCWidth detect plate spring幅検知板λ"リフ
15LPLTP0234QSZZAEDSCWidth detect plate幅検知7レト
16MLEVP0035QSE2ACDJCOriginal detect actuator原稿検知がは工一
17CPWBF0106QSE4APEQEManual paper feed VR PWB手差レVR基板
18LSOU-0025QSTC-ASEQDManual paper feed tray 1 lower[Missing parts code] 手差レフ1下1st lot
19VHPGP1S73P+-18AFDSBPhoto sensor(GP1S73P)手は工一
20LSOU-0027QSTC-APEQDManual paper feed tray 2 lower[Missing parts code] 手差レフ12下1st lot
22XEBS730P06000AADDCScrew(3×6)t'λ
(Unit)
901CSOU-0024RS65BFGNEManual paper feed tray unit (Except Japan)手差レフハト
CSOU-0024RS66BFGNEManual paper feed tray unit (Japan)手差レフハト

13 手差卜(Multi manual paper feed tray unit)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 補修部品の兰ク付 - 4

14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1PCOVP 01 07QSTFALEBDMulti frame cover N1###-N1
2XEBS 30P 10000ACDDCScrew(3×10)###
3PSHEZ 0099QSZZACDJCProtect sheet S防振手套S
4NROLR 0922FCZZARZZCManual paper feed roller手差L-1A-
5NGERH 0223QSZZACDJCGear(20T)###
6XPSSJ 20-07000AADDCSpring pin(φ2-7)###-L-1B-1C
7NGERH 0061QSZZADDJCGear(24T)###
8MARP 0009QSZ1AFDSCRoller arm###-L-1A-
9MSPRT 0351QSZZACDJCRoller arm spring###-L-1A-###-1B-1C
10NROLR 1267FCZ1AHDXCPick up roller呼达勿拉-1A-
11NSFT Z0096QSZ1AFDSCRoller shaft F N###-L-1A-###-1F N
12XRESP 40-06000AADDCE type ring(E4)E ###-1C
13LBSHZ0303FCZZACDJCM bushing CM ###-1C
14LBOSZ0150QSZZAEDSCCam boss A2 N###-A2 N
15MSPRC 1315FCZ1ADDJCManual paper feed clutch spring A手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
16PP i PP0 109FCZ1ACDJCManual paper feed clutch sleeve A pipe手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
17LBOSZ 0199QSZZAEDSCCam boss A1###-A1
18MARP 0041QSZZAEDSCCam transmission arm加压速动-1A-
19MARMP 0006QSZZADDJCFulcrum arm###-1A-
20MSPRD 0347QSZZADDJCStopper arm spring###-7-1A-###-1A-1C
21MCAMP 0003QSZZADDJCDrive cam驱动机
22MSPRC 1316FCZ1AEDSCManual paper feed clutch spring B手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
23PP i PP0014QSZZACDJCCam clutch sleeve加压速动-1A-1C
24NSFT Z0017QSP1ADDJCManual paper feed cum shaft手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
25NGERH 0972FCZZABDJCGear(27T)###-1A-
26CPLTM 0345QS01AGDXCPaper feed connect plate TLPD給紙接縫板TLPD
27XEBS 730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)###-1A-
28PTME-0178FCZ1ACDJCManual paper feed pawl A手差L-1A-1A
29MSPRC 2175FCZZAADJCPawl A spring爪A-1A-1A-1C
30RPLU-0028QSZZAMEGBMulti field solenoid###-1A-###-1A-1C
RPLU-0028QSPZ1AMEGBMulti field solenoid###-1A-###-1A-1C
31MSPRC 1318FCZ1AADJCManual paper feed spring B手差L-1A-###-1B-1C
32PTME-0179FCZZACDDCManual paper feed pawl B手差L-1A-###-1B-1C
33XEBS 730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×10)###-1A-
34XEBS 730P10000AADDCManual paper feed tray arm手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
35MARP 0027QSZ1AEDJCMulti frame###-1A-###-1A-1C
36LFRM-0048QSTHASEQDMulti frame###-1A-###-1A-1C
37MARP 0008QSZZAHDXCStopper arm###-1A-###-1A-1C
38LPLTP 0056QSZ3ADDJCStopper plate###-1A-###-1A-1C
39XEPS 730P06X00AADDCScrew(3×6X)###-1A-
40XEBS 730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10)###-1A-
41PSEZ 20241QSZZABDJCManual paper feed protection sheet手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
42LBNDJ0013FCZ1AEDJCBand结束####
43NSFT Z0090QSZZAGDXCRoller shaft R N###-1A-###-1A-1C
44MSPRD 0302QSZZACDJCManual paper feed coupling spring手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
45MSPRD 0329QSZZACDJCRevers ACT spring反転ACT ###-1A-1C
46NCPL-0012QSZZADDJCManual paper feed coupling手差L-1A-###-1A-1C
47CPWBF 0083QSE5AUEZESensor PWB###-1A-基板
48DHA i-0360QSPZAEDJCDUP 2 sensor harnessDUP 2 ###-###-1A-1C
49MLEVP 0104QSZZADDJCRevers lever反転####
50LBSHZ0006QSZZACDJCM bushing 2M ###-1A-###-2C
51LSTPP0011QSZZACDJCResin E type ring树脂 E-###-1C
52LX-WZ0111QSZZABDDCPoly slider(5-12-0.5)###-1A-
(Unit)
901CFRM-0048RS 55BEGNEMulti manual paper feed unit(Without No.36,40,41,43)###-1A-###-1A-1C

14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 1

15 DV 1=yt (DV unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1LHLDZ0142QSZZADDJCFilter holder\( \text{ ナリフ}-\text{ イフ} \) -
2PF i LD0313FCZZAGDXATN filterTN 750-1
3XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)\( t^*λ \)
4PG i DM0158QSZZAHDXCCartridge guide top加一 ナリフ・ガト"上
5PSEL-0162QSZZAEDJADV bladeDV 75-1
6LX-BZ1066FCZZACDDCBlue screw(3×6)青 75-1
7PG i DM0159QSZZAMEGCCartridge guide bottom加一 ナリフ・ガト"下
8PMLT-0137QSZZ-ADDJCPipe cushion N[Missing parts code] \( \text{ ナリフ} \) -N
9PMLT-0142QSZZACDJCPipe cover cushion N\( \text{ ナリフ} \) -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" - " -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -1st lot
10PSEL-0964FCZ1AADJCCover upper seal加一 上75-1
11PMLT-0141QSZZACDJCDV guide cushion NDV 75-1" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -"1
12PMLT-0147QSZZABDJCDV side cushion RDV 75-1" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" - "1
13LDA i U0033QSZZACDJCDV block RDV 75-1" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -"1
14NROLP0150QSZZASEQCMX roller LMX 75-1-L
15NROLP0149QSZZASEQCMX roller RMX 75-1-R
16PMLT-0146QSZZABDJCDV side cushion FDV 75-1" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -'1
17XEBS730P06000AADDCScrew(3×6)\( t^*λ \)
18LHLDZ0132QSZ1ACDJCScraper holder\( \text{ ナリフ} \) -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" - "1
19PBOX-0025QSZZAMEGCDV BOXDV 75-1" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -1
20DHA i 0566QSPZAQEQCToner sensor harness\( \text{ 加一 } \) -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" -" - "1
21XRESP40-06000AADDCE ring(E4)\( E \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "1
22NBRGY0769FCZ2AQEBCMG bearing\( \text{ MG } \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "2
23NPLYZ0041QSZZACDJCMX pulley\( \text{ MX} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ''2
24LPL0194QSZZACDJCDV box fixing plate現像槽固定板
25XBPSS30P06KS0ABDDCScrew(3×6KS)\( t^*λ \)
26NPLYZ0040QSZZACDJCMG pulley\( \text{ MG } \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "2
27NBLTH0494FCZZADDJBDV belt\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "24
28PSHEZ0652QSZZAADJADV side sheet F\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "2
29XBBBS730P04000AADDCScrew(3×4)\( t^*λ \)
30PSHEZ0651QSZZAADJADV side sheet R\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "2
31XRESP50-06000AADDCE ring(E5)\( \text{ E } \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' - "
32XEBS730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10)\( t^*λ \)
33NBRGC0020QSZZAHDDCDMX bearing(F6/14)\( \text{ DMX} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' - "
34NGERH1653FCZZACDJCDMX gear(24T)\( \text{ DMX} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' - "
35LX-BZ1143FCPZADDJCScrew\( t^*λ \)
36LHLDZ0128QSZZACDJCDV holder F\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "
37MSPRDO0395QSZZACDJCBias spring\( \text{ N } \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "
38LHLDZ0129QSZZACDJCMG holder\( \text{ MG} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' - "
39PCOVP0122QSZZAFDSDDV cover F\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' - "
40NROLM0151QSZZ-BTNECMG roller[Missing parts code] \( \text{ M } \) " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - "1
41PMLT-0002YSZ1ACDJCDV TH cushionDVTH " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " " " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " -"2
42PSHEP0632QSZZABDJCDoctor cover seal\( \text{ 前 } \) "加一 "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一'- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一""
43LPLTM0002YSZ4AREQCDoctor reinforce plate\( t^*λ \)
44PLTLM0477QSZZAKEBCDV doctor\( \text{ DV} \) ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' "
45XBPBZ30P03000ABDDCScrew(3×3)\( t^*λ \)
46PCOVP0121QSZZAEDJCDoctor cover\( \text{ 前 } \) "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"- "加一"\( \text{ t^*λ} \)
47XBBZ30P06000ACDDCScrew(3×6)\( t^*λ \)
48RDTCM0021QSZZAYFQBATC sensorATC 75-1
49XUBUZ30P08000AADDCScrew(3×8)\( t^*λ \)
501CHLDZ0142RS51-ANEGEFilter holder unit[Missing parts code] \( \text{ ナリフ} \) - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " - " -"
(Unit)
901DUNT-0777RSZZBNHZEDV unitDV 工厂

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 2

16 7.(Process unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)£'s
2PCAPH0022QSZZACDJDToner pipe cap扑-ハ" ナマリフ"
3NSRW-0002QSZZAEDSCTransport pipe screw搬送ハ" ナマリフ"
4LPLTM0241QSZZAFDSCProcess reinforce plate7" ナス補強板
5MLEVFP0065QSZZAEDSCSeparator pawl lever剥離爪い"
6CFRMA-0049RS76-AZFQAProcess frame unit [Missing parts code][Missing parts code]1st lot
7NCPL-0003QSZ1ACDJCScrew couplingクルーハーフ" ナス"
10PSEL-0071QSZZAFDSASeal RはさトR
11PSEL-0070QSZZAFDSASeal FはさトF
12PSHT-0014QSZZACDJCToner pipe shutter扑-ハ" ナマリフ"
13PP I PP0017QSZZAEDSCToner pipe扑-ハ" ナス"
14MSPRC0045QSZ1ACDJCToner pipe spring扑-ハ" ナス"
15PSPAZ0696FCZZACDJCPipe cap spacer[able]
16NGERH0036QSZZACDJCTransport screw gear(30T)搬送ハリス-さト
17PCOV0132QSZZAFDSDDrum cover[able]
18NGERH0039QSZZAEDSCTransport pipe gear(14T)搬送ハリス-さト
19LFIX-0015QSZZAEDJCDrum fixing plate B (Inch series,AB Series agency)[able]固定板B
LFIX-0014QSZZAEDJCDrum fixing plate A (Except Inch series,AB Series agency)[able]固定板A
20NGERH0037QSZZACDJCIdle gear(26T)[able]
21NGERH0038QSZZACDJCTransport pipe gear(15T)搬送ハリス-さト
22NSFTZ0020QSZ1ALDSCTransport screw搬送ハリス-
23NBRGP0299FCPZADDJCDV bearingDV 軸受
24PMLT-0018QSZ1ACDJCTransport screw cushion搬送ハリス-モト
25PTME-0021QSZZAKDXCSeparator pawl剥離爪
26LX-WZ0329FCPZABDDCWasher[able]
27LX-RZ0001QSZZABDDCStar ring[able]
28MSPRT0214QSZZABDJCLever spring[able]
29LX-BZ0064QSZZAADDCScrew(3×8)[able]
30MSPRC0213QSZZABDJCSeparator pawl spring剥離爪[able]
31CHLDZ0035RS58-AWFGAMC holder unit [Missing parts code]MC ナス-ルト1st lot
32CCLEZ0011QS32BDGNACleaning brade[able]
UCLEZ0011QSZ1-BRMJACleaning blade [Missing parts code][able]
33XEBS730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10)[able]
34PSHEZ0329QSZZACDJCToner stir sheet扑-攤拌ト
35PTPE-0026QSZ1AADJCScrew tapeクルーハーフ"
36LHLDZ0090QSZZACDJCStar ring holder扑-ハ" ナス"
37LX-BZ0406FCPZAADDCScrew(3×4)[able]
38PRNGF0106FCZ2ACDJAStar ring N2[able]
39PRNGP0081FCZ1ABDJCResin E ring(E4)樹脂 E ナス"
40PSEZ0557QSZZACDJCDR brake sheet[able]
41XBBS730P06000ACDDCScrew(3×6)[able]
501CP i PP0017RS51-ANEGEToner pipe unit [Missing parts code]扑-ハ" ナス-ルト1st lot
502CTME-0021RS51AKEBASeparator pawl unit剥離爪ト
(Unit)
901CFRM-0049RS5NBGGTEProcess unit(Without No.19,44)[able]

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 3

17 定着1=1t1(Fusing unit 1)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1MARP0 0 48QSZ2-AFDSCPressure release fulcrum arm [Missing parts code] 压解支点7-41st lot
2MLEVP0 1 00QSZZ-AEDSCPressure release lever F TL 压解1' - F TL
3MLEVP0 1 01QSZZ-AEDSCPressure release lever R TL 压解1' - R TL
8RTHM-0 0 50FCZZ-ANEGBThermostat TL - 越动TL
10DHA i - 0 367QSPZ-AEDJCDUP sensor harness 损失(3×6)
11LHLDW0 0 86QSZZ-ABDJCHarness ring - 越动TL
12RH-HX0 0 01QSLB-ATEZBThermistor TL - 越动TL
13LPLTM0 3 38QSZ1-ACDJCFusing earth plate UR 定着7-板UR
14VHPGP1 0 73P-18-AFDSBPhoto sensor(GP1SQ73P) 变化
15XEBS7 30P0 6000-AADDCScrew(3×6)
XEBS7 30P0 6000-AADDCScrew(3×6) [To No.51]
18LSTPF0 1 72FCZZ-AADDCRoller stopper - 越动TL -09/07 mid
19RLMPU0 0 40QSPZ-BAFXBHeater lamp (120V) -
RLMPU0 0 41QSPZ-BAFXBHeater lamp (230V) -
RLMPU0 0 39QSPZ-BAFXBHeater lamp (100V) -
22LHLDZ0 1 39QSZZ-ADDJCLamp fixing plate - 取付板
23LFRM-0 098QSZZ-AVFGDFusing upper frame(TL) 定着上TL -
24MSPRC0 3 23QSZZ-ACDJCFusing unit earth spring - 越动TL -
25LPLTM0 3 37QSZ1-ACDJCFusing earth plate UF 定着7-板UF
27NROLM0 1 29QSZZ-BBFXAHeat roller(TL) -
28NGERH01 7 1QSZZ-AREQAFusing gear(TL)(38T) 定着T -
29NBRGP0 0 25QSZZ-ANEQAUpper HR bearing(TL) 上HR 轴受
30LPLTM0 3 43QSZZ-ABDJCGear key plate(TL) -
31CPLTM0 3 36QS02-AREQAFusing cleaner plate 定着TL-板
32MSPRT0 2 57QSZ1-ACDJCUpper paw spring 定着TL-板
33MSPRD0 3 22QSZZ-ACDJCFusing ACT return spring 定着ACT 復制TL -
34MLEVP0 0 99QSZ1-AFDSCFusing rear paper detect lever 定着後用紙換知TL -
35PGiDM01 1 13QSZZ-ATEZCFusing rear upper guide 定着後上PG
36PTME-0 282FCZZ-AHDXAUpper separate pawl 上刺離爪
37LX-WZ0 0 06QSZZ-ACDDCWasher 刺離爪 -
38PTME-0 0 24QSZ2-ANEQAUpper separate pawl 上刺離爪LPD
39LX-BZ0 0 86QSPZ-ADDJCFusing unit fixing screw 定着TL-板 取付T -
40CPLTM0 513QS01-AFDSAThermistor felt fixing plate [Missing parts code] - 越动TL - 取付板1st lot
41LX-BZ1 1 95FCZZ-ACDDCScrew(M3) -
42LSTYM0 0 04QSZZ-AKDXCFusing upper frame stay And3 定着上TL-板 And3
43LPLTM0 510QSZZ-ADDJCEarth joint plate - 越动TL-板 And3
44LX-BZ1 1 81FCZZ-ABDDCScrew(3×6) -
45LPLTM0 4 73QSZZ-AEDJCFusing earth plate And3 定着7-板 And3
46LX-BZ1 1 26FCPZ-ABDDCThermister screw - 越动TL -
47XHPS7 3 04000-ABDDCScrew(3×4) -
48XWHS7 3 0-05080-AADDCWasher - 越动TL -
49LX-BZ0 0 93QSZZ-ACDDCScrew - 越动TL -
50PCOPV01 4 88QSZZ-AKDXCThermostat cover - 越动TL-板 -
51NXBBS7 3 0P06000-ACDDCScrew(3×4) [From No.15] - 越动TL-板 -
(Unit)
901DUNTW0 7 82RSZZ-BWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 18) (120V) 定着TL - (7° D' 18 含t)
DUNTW0 7 82RS12-BWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 18) (230V) 定着TL - (7° D' 18 含t)
DUNTW0 7 82RS11-BWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 18) (100V) 定着TL - (7° D' 18 含t)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 4

18 定着1=2(Fusing unit 2)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1NBRGY 0 0 2 QSZZALEBAFusing pressure bearing FU 加压軸受
2NROLR 0 1 5 6 QSZZBFGNAFusing roller 压着ローナ
3MSPRC 0 3 2 4 QSZZACDJCFusing pressure spring(TL) 定着加压 ムリウ
5LPL TM 0 3 4 1 QSZ1ACDJCFusing earth plate(DR) 定着7-8板
7LPL TM 0 5 3 1 QSZZ-ACDJCHigh resistor earth plate And3 [Missing parts code] [Missing parts code] And31st lot
8PG i DH 0 1 4 0 QSZZAYFQAFusing front guide 定着前がト
9LPL TM 0 3 4 0 QSZZACDJCFusing earth plate(DF) 定着7-8板
11MSPRD 0 3 2 8 QSZ1ACDJCLower pawl spring(RTL) 下爪7-8R
12PTME-0 0 4 1 QSZZAGDSALower separate pawl 下剥離爪
13TCAUH 0 0 1 7 QSZ1ACDJDHigh temperature caution label (Except Japan) 高温注意は%
TLABH 0 3 8 1 QSZZAEDJDHigh temperature caution label (Japan) 高温注意は%
14XBPSN 3 0 0 8 KS0AADDCScrew(3×8KS) ムλ
15MSPRD 0 3 2 7 QSZ1ACDJCLower pawl spring F(TL) 下爪7-8R F
16LFRM-0 0 7 2 QSZ5-ATEQDFusing lower frame [Missing parts code] 定着下ルス1st lot
17MSPRD 0 3 2 6 QSZZACDJCFusing rear lower guide spring 定着後下が [復鳬7-8R]
18PG i DM 0 1 1 5 QSZZASEQCFusing rear lower guide 定着後下が [復鳬7-8R]
19TLABH 0 2 8 9 QSZZAADJDFusing green label 定着7-8R [Except Japan] 高温注意は%
20MLEVF 0 1 1 1 QSZZADDJCPressure lever F(AND2) 加压レフ - F
21MLEVF 0 1 1 2 QSZZADDJCPressure lever R(AND2) 加压レフ - R
22TLABH 0 6 8 5 QSZZADDJDHigh temperature caution label (Except Japan) 高温注意は%
TLABH 0 6 8 3 QSZZAEDJDHigh temperature caution label (Japan) 高温注意は%
23VRH- ST 2 HB 5 0 7 K-ADDJCResistor(500MΩ) [Missing parts code] 担抗 (500MΩ)09/07 mid
24XWHS 7 4 0-0 8 0 9 0AADDCWasher ムツロー
(Unit)
901DUNTW 0 7 8 2 RSZZBWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 17) (120V) 定着7-8R (7-8R) 17 含む)
DUNTW 0 7 8 2 RS 1 2BWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 17) (230V) 定着7-8R (7-8R) 17 含む)
DUNTW 0 7 8 2 RS 1 1BWRJEFusing unit(Include Block 17) (100V) 定着7-8R (7-8R) 17 含む)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 5

19 驱動トDrive unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changecPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XBP S7 40 P08ES0ABDDCScrew(4×8ES)b'λ
2RMOTP 0069QSPZBAFXBMain motorm'v-à-à-
3CPLTM0160QS02AUFGCMain drive platem'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
4MSPRC0200QSZ1ABDJCRatchet springm'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
NGERH0234QSZZAFDSCRatchet gear(49T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-á-
5NGERH0234QSZZAFDSCFusing drive gear(19T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à -
6NGERH0090QSZ1AKDXCGear(94/21T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
7NGERH0084QSZZAKDXCGear(94/21T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
8XRESP70-08000AADDCE type ring(E7)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à -
9NGERH0192QSZZADDJCGear(46/19T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
10NGERH0086QSZZADDJCGear(39/21T)[MX-M260/M260N/M260FP/M260FG, AR-5726]
NGERH0190QSZZACDJCGear(39/19T)[MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
11NGERH0087QSZZAEDJCGear(30/21T)[MX-M260/M260N/M260FP/M260FG, AR-5726]
NGERH0189QSZZADDJCGear(30/21T)[MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
12NGERH0010QSZZADDJCGear(28T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
13NGERH0092QSZZADDJCGear(30/16T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-ã-
14NGERH0093QSZZADDJCGear(28/16T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à -
15XBPS730P06KS0ABDDCScrew(3×6KS)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-
16NGERH0095QSZZAEDJCGearm'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
NGERH0191QSZZACDJCMG gearMg'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
17NGERH0186QSZZAHDXCN gear(58/21T)N'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
18NGERH0186QSZZAEDHCGear(37/25T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
19NGERH0096QSZZAEDJCGear(37/25T)m'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
20CPLTM0161QS02APEQCSub drive platem'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
21MSPRC0262QSZ1ACDJCMG springMg'v-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-à-â-
22NCPL -0009QSZZACDJCMG couplingMg'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ"
23NGERH0091QSZZAEDJCCoupling gear(34T)m'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ' âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ' âvâ 'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ 'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ' âvâ -
24CPLTM0161QS01ACDDCPoly slider AND2m'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvã -
25DHA i -0602QSPZAEDSCAN2R main motor harnessm'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvå -
26LX-WZ0012QSZZABDDCDrive unit [MX-M260/M260N/M260FP/M260FG, AR-5726]
27XRESP50 -06000AADDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
28LX-WZ0476FCZZACDDCPoly sliderm'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvô -
29LX-WZ0407FCZZABDDCPoly sliderm'v-âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvâ'âvã -
30Unit
901CPLTM0160RS59BHHCEDrive unit [MX-M260/M260N/M260FP/M260FG, AR-5726]
30CPLTM0160RS60BHHCEDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
31CPLTM0160RS70ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
32CPLTM0160RS80ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
33CPLTM0160RS90ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
34CPLTM0160RS100ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
35CPLTM0160RS101ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
36CPLTM0160RS102ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
37CPLTM0160RS103ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
38CPLTM0160RS104ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
39CPLTM0160RS105ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
40CPLTM0160RS106ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
41CPLTM0160RS107ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
42CPLTM0160RS108ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
43CPLTM0160RS109ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
44CPLTM0160RS20ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
45CPLTM0160RS21ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
46CPLTM0160RS22ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
47CPLTM0160RS23ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
48CPLTM0160RS24ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
49CPLTM0160RS25ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
50CPLTM0160RS26ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
51CPLTM0160RS27ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
52CPLTM0160RS28ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
53CPLTM0160RS29ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
54CPLTM0160RS30ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
55CPLTM0160RS31ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
56CPLTM0160RS32ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
57CPLTM0160RS33ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
58CPLTM0160RS34ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
59CPLTM0160RS35ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
60CPLTM0160RS36ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
61CPLTM0160RS37ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
62CPLTM0160RS38ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
63CPLTM0160RS39ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
64CPLTM0160RS40ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
65CPLTM0160RS41ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
66CPLTM0160RS42ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
67CPLTM0160RS43ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
68CPLTM0160RS44ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
69CPLTM0160RS45ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]
70CPLTM0160RS46ACDDCDrive unit [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG, AR-5731]

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 14手差L給紙(Multi manual paper feed unit) - 6

20 第一排紙1(1st delivery paper unit 1)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1NSFTZ0042QSZ1AEDSCDelivery sub roller shaft排紙從動-0-軸
3NROLP0049QSZZACDJCDelivery sub roller排紙從動-0-軸
4NROLP0111QSZZADDJCDelivery sub roller(Large)排紙從動-0-軸(大)
6PBRSR0019QSZZAKDXBDischarger brush LP除電7''JPLP
7NROLR0114QSZZAREZCDelivery roller C排紙0-0-C
8NBRGY2122SCZZABDDCTransport roller bearing搬送0-0軸受
9LPLTM0195QSZZACDJCDelivery earth plate A排紙7-7板A
10NBRGM0501FCZZABDJCBearing軸受
11XRESP50-06000AADDCE type ring(E5)E'LL"
12LHLDZ0058QSZ3AQEQCDelivery roller holder排紙0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0
13LPLTP0185QSZZALEBCDelivery change gate排紙切替0-1-
14MSPRD0224QSZZABDJCDelivery actuator spring排紙7''J1-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-1-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0
15MLEVP0055QSZ1ACDJCDelivery actuator排紙7''J1-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0
16MSPRT0197QSZ1ACDJCDelivery sub spring排紙從動0''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1''J1'' 0"λ
17XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3x8)t''λ
18CPWBFO222QSE3AKEBESensor PWBSET-基板
21CSFTZ0023QS04AEDSCShifter shaftNorth America)SL7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7
CSFTZ0023QS01AHDXCShifter shaft(Except North America)SL7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7-7
22XRESP40-06000AADDCE type ring(E4)E''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''L''
23LFRM-0038QSZ5AZFXCDelivery frame排紙7''L1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1
24NROLR0051QSZ1ALEBCDUP delivery rollerDUP 排紙0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-0-
25LBSHZ0303FCZZACDJCM bushing CM''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''
26PGiDM0165QSZ1AREQCDelivery upper paper guide排紙上"↑"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"—"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"——"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"ー"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"二"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"三"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"一"1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1-1 -
27NROLP1122FCZZAFDSCPS upper rollerPS 上口一
28MSPRT0229GCAZACDJCFU spring RFU 7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7''7'' 0"λ
29XHBS740P10000AADDCScrew(4x10)t''λ
30LZX-BZ0780FCZACDDCScrewt''λ
31PSHEZ0650QSZABDJCDelivery hole sheet B排紙孔孔径 B
32PSHEZ0649QSZAADDCDelivery hole sheet A[Missing parts code]1st lot
33PSHEZ0655QSZADDJCDelivery fan connector sheet排紙7''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78'' 0"λ
34PF i LZ0017QSZ1APEQAOzone filter0''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T'' T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''T''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78''78'' 0"λ
35LZX-BZ099QSZABDDCScrew[Missing parts code]t''λ
36LPLTM0509QSZACDJCOF fixing plateOF 担元JLEト
37NFANP0020QSPZAPEQBFan motor ANR2frans-e-t-A/NR2
(Unit)
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171/172/173/174/175/176/177/178/179/180/181/182/183/184/185/186/187/188/189/190/191/192/193/194/195/196/197/198/199/200/201/202/203/204/205/206/207/208/209/210/211/212/213/214/215/216/217/218/219/220/221/222/223/224/225/226/227/228/229/230/231/232/233/234/235/236/237/238/239/240/241/242/243/244/245/246/247/248/249/250/251/252/253/254/255/256/257/258/259/260/261/262/263/264/265/266/267/268/269/270/271/272/273/274/275/276/277/278/279/280/281/282/283/284/285/286/287/288/289/290/291/292/293/294/295/296/297/298/299/300/301/302/303/304/305/306/307/308/309/310/311/312/313/314/315/316/317/318/319/320/321/322/323/324/325/326/327/328/329/330/331/332/333/334/335/336/337/338/339/340/341/342/343/344/345/346/347/348/349/350/351/352/353/354/355/356/357/358/359/360/361/362/363/364/365/366/367/368/369/370/371/372/373/374/375/376/377/378/379/380/381/382/383/384/385/386/387/388/389/390/391/392/393/394/395/396/397/398/399/400/401/402/403/404/405/406/407/408/409/410/411/412/413/414/415/416/417/418/419/420/421/422/423/424/425/426/427/428/429/430/431/432/433/434/435/436/437/438/439/440/441/442/443/444/445/446/447/448/449/450/451/452/453/454/455/456/457/458/459/460/461/462/463/464/465/466/467/468/469/470/471/472/473/474/475/476/477/478/479/480/481/482/483/484/485/486/487/488/489/490/491/492/493/494/495/496/497/498/499/500/501/502/503/504/505/506/507/508/509/510/511/512/513/514/515/516/517/518/519/520/521/522/523/524/525/526/527/528/529/530/531/532/533/534/535/536/537/538/539/540/541/542/543/544/545/546/547/548/549/550/551/552/553/554/555/556/557/558/559/560/561/562/563/564/565/566/567/568/569/570/571/572/573/574/575/576/577/578/579/580/581/582/583/584/585/586/587/588/589/590/591/592/593/594/595/596/597/598/599/600/601/602/603/604/605/606/607/608/609/610/611/612/613/614/615/616/617/618/619/620/621/622/623/624/625/626/627/628/629/630/631/632/633/634/635/636/637/638/639/640/641/642/643/644/645/646/647/648/649/650/651/652/653/654/655/656/657/658/659/660/661/662/663/664/665/666/667/668/669/670/671/672/673/674/675/676/677/678/679/680/681/682/683/684/685/686/687/688/689/690/691/692/693/694/695/696/697/698/699/700/701/702/703/704/705/706/707/708/709/710/711/712/713/714/715/716/717/718/719/720/721/722/723/724/725/726/727/728/729/730/731/732/733/734/735/736/737/738/739/740/741/742/743/744/745/746/747/748/749/750/751/752/753/754/755/756/757/758/759/760/761/762/763/764/765/766/767/768/769/770/771/772/773/774/775/776/777/778/779/780/781/782/783/784/785/786/787/788/789/790/791/792/793/794/795/796/797/798/799/800/801/802/803/804/805/806/807/808/809/810/811/812/813/814/815/816/817/818/819/820/821/822/823/824/825/826/827/828/829/830/831/832/833/834/835/836/837/838/839/840/841/842/843/844/845/846/847/848/849/850/851/852/853/854/855/856/857/858/859/860/861/862/863/864/865/866/867/868/869/870/871/872/873/874/875/876/877/878/879/880/881/882/883/884/885/886/887/888/889/890/891/892/893/894/895/896/897/898/899/900/901/902/903/904/905/906/907/908/909/910/911/912/913/914/915/916/917/918/919/920/921/922/923/924/925/926/927/928/929/930/931/932/933/934/935/936/937/938/939/940/941/942/943/944/945/946/947/948/949/950/951/952/953/954/955/956/957/958/959/960/961/962/963/964/965/966/967/968/969/970/971/972/973/974/975/976/977/978/979/980/981/982/983/984/985/986/987/988/989/990/991/992/993/994/995/996/997/998/999/1000/1010/1020/1030/1040/1050/1060/1070/1080/1090/1100/1110/1120/1130/1140/1150/1160/1170/1180/1190/1200/1210/1220/1230/1240/1250/1260/1270/1280/1290/1300/1310/1320/1330/1340/1350/1360/1370/1380/1390/1400/1410/1420/1430/1440/1450/1460/1470/1480/1490/1500/1510/1520/1530/1540/1550/1560/1570/1580/1590/1600/1610/1620/1630/1640/1650/1660/1670/1680/1690/1700/1710/1720/1730/1740/1750/1760/1770/1780/1790/1800/1810/1820/1830/1840/1850/1860/1870/1880/1890/1900/1910/1920/1930/1940/1950/1960/1970/1980/1990/2000/2010/2020/2030/2040/2050/2060/2070/2080/2090/2100/2110/2120/2130/2140/2150/2160/2170/2180/2190/2200/2210/2220/2230/2240/2250/2260/2270/2280/2290/2300/2310/2320/2330/2340/2350/2360/2370/2380/2390/2400/2410/2420/2430/2440/2450/2460/2470/2480/2490/2500/2510/2520/2530/2540/2550/2560/2570/2580/2590/2600/2610/2620/2630/2640/2650/2660/2670/2680/2690/2700/2710/2720/2730/2740/2750/2760/2770/2780/2790/2800/2810/2820/2830/2840/2850/2860/2870/2880/2890/2900/2910/2920/2930/2940/2950/2960/2970/2980/2990/3000/3010/3020/3030/3040/3050/3060/3070/3080/3090/3100/3110/3120/3130/3140/3150/3160/3170/3180/3190/3200/3210/3220/3230/3240/3250/3260/3270/3280/3290/3300/3310/3320/3330/3340/3350/3360/3370/3380/3390/3400/3410/3420/3430/3440/3450/3460/3470/3480/3490/3500/3510/3520/3530/3540/3550/3560/3570/3580/3590/3600/3610/3620/3630/3640/3650/3660/3670/3680/3690/3700/3710/3720/3730/3740/3750/3760/3770/3780/3790/3800/3810/3820/3830/3840/3850/3860/3870/3880/3890/3900/3910/3920/3930/3940/3950/3960/3970/3980/3990/4000/4010/4020/4030/4040/4050/4060/4070/4080/4090/4100/4110/4120/4130/4140/4150/4160/4170/4180/4190/4200/4210/4220/4230/4240/4250/4260/4270/4280/4290/4300/4310/4320/4330/4340/4350/4360/4370/4380/4390/4400/4410/4420/4430/4440/4450/4460/4470/4480/4490/4500/4510/4520/4530/4540/4550/4560/4570/4580/4590/4600/4610/4620/4630/4640/4650/4660/4670/4680/4690/4700/4710/4720/4730/4740/4750/4760/4770/4780/4790/4800/4810/4820/4830/4840/4850/4860/4870/4880/4890/4900/4910/4920/4930/4940/4950/4960/4970/4980/4990/5000/5010/5020/5030/5040/5050/5060/5070/5080/5090/5100/5110/5120/5130/5140/5150/5160/5170/5180/5190/5200/5210/5220/5230/5240/5250/5260/5270/5280/5290/5300/5310/5320/5330/5340/5350/5360/5370/5380/5390/5400/5410/5420/5430/5440/5450/5460/5470/5480/5490/5500/5510/5520/5530/5540/5550/5560/5570/5580/5590/5600/5610/5620/5630/5640/5650/5660/5670/5680/5690/5700/5710/5720/5730/5740

20 第一排紙1-1b 1(1st delivery paper unit 1)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 第一排紙1-1b 1(1st delivery paper unit 1) - 1

21 第一排紙12(1st delivery paper unit 2)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART MARKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XHBS730P08000ABDDCScrew(3×8)(Except North America) ヒλ
2RMOTSO071QSPZBDGJBShifter motor(Except North America) フフロー-
3CPLTM0184QS03AHDXCShifter drive plate(Except North America) フフロー-
4XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)
5MSPRD0225QSZZACDJCStopper return spring(Except North America) フフロー- 微梯 则"リフ"
6LSTPP0003QSZ1ACDJCShifter stopper(Except North America) フフロー-
7NGERH0068QSZ1ADDJCShifter gear(50T)(Except North America) フフロー-
8NGERH0067QSZZADDJCShifter gear(24T)(Except North America) フフロー-
9VHPGP1A71L3-18AGDSBPhoto sensor(GP1A71L3)(Except North America) フフロー-
11XRESP30-06000AADDCE type ring(E3)(Except North America) E"リフ"
12XRESP40-06000AADDCE type ring(E4)(Except North America) E"リフ"
13MSPRD0216QSZZADDJCShifter earth spring(Exe"フフロー- 微梯 则"リフ"
14MSPRT0217QSZ1ACDJCGate return spring(Exe"ト復梯 则"リフ"
15LBRC-0002QSZ1ACDJCGate bracket(Exe"フフロー- フフロー-
16LBSHZ030FCZZACDJCM bushing CM フフロー- C
17NBRGY2122SCZZABDDCTransport roller bearing搬送ローネーヤーハ受
18NBRGC0019QSZZADDJCBearing(φ6)轴受
19XPSSJ30-08000AADDCSpring pin(φ3-8)(Exe"リフロー- フフロー-
20NBLTT0024QSZZAGDSBDrive belt 240驱動電圧 240
21NGERH0080QSZZAEDJCDelivery drive gear(25/31T)接続験動 フフロー-
22NGERH0082QSZZADDJCDUP delivery gear(20/31T)DUP 接続電圧
23MSPRD0198QSZZACDJCDelivery earth spring B排紙7-ス フフロー- B
24NGERH0113QSZZACDJCIdle gear B(29T)(Exe"リフロー- B
25NGERH0114QSZZACDJCIdle gear C(29T)(Exe"リフロー- C
26MSPRD0196QSZZACDJCDelivery earth spring A接続電圧 フフロー- フフロー- A
27NGERH0155QSZZADDJCGear(31/39T)F" フフロー-
28RPLU-0027QSZZAUEZBChange gate solenoid切替電圧 フフロー- フフロー-
RPLU-0027QSPZ1AUEZBChange gate solenoid切替電圧 フフロー- フフロー-09/09
29CBRC-0004QS03AFDSCDUP motor fixing bracketDUP フフロー- 取付電圧
30RMOTSO070QSPZBDGJBDUP motorDUP フフロー-
31XHBS730P08000ABDDCScrew(3×8)F" フフロー-
32XBBS726P03000-AADDCScrew(2.6×3)[Missing parts code] フフロー(2.6×3)1st lot
33XWHS730-05070AADDCWasher[缺効]
34LHLDW1334FCZZ-AADJCWire holder[缺効]1st lot
35PSHEZ0316QSZZADDJCDelivery motor sheet接続電圧 フフロー-
36PRDAZ0002QSZZADDJCDelivery motor radiation plate排紙7-ス 放熱板
37PSHEZ0341QSZZAADJCShifter stop mylar(Exe North America) フフロー-
38CFMR-0038RS76-AXFGEShifter unit (Except North America)[Exe North America] フフロー-
39CFMR-0038RS54-BAFXEDUP motor fixing bracket unit [Missing parts code] DUP フフロー- 取付電圧 フフロー-1st lot
40Unit
901CFRM-0038RS74BPLPE1st delivery unit(Include Block 20) (North America) 1st 接紙電圧 (70% 20 含心)
CFRM-0038RS76-BQLPE1st delivery unit(Include Block 20) (Missing parts code) 1st 接紙電圧 (Except North America, Japan) (70% 20 含心)1st lot

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 第一排紙1-1b 1(1st delivery paper unit 1) - 2
21 第一排紙1-2(1st delivery paper unit 2)

22 基板部(PWB section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1CPWBX0136QS3LCBTXEIMC PWB [MX-M260/M260N/M260FP/M260FG,AR-5726] IMC基板
CPWBX0136QS3MCBTXEIMC PWB [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP,AR-5731] IMC基板
2XBBS730P0800AADDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
3PSPAB039QSZZAGDJCSpacerλ''-μ''
4CPWBF0235QSE1BBGDEOption interface PWB打'√中继基板
5XBBS830P0800AADDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
6DHA i-0611QSPZ-AVFGCAN2R MCU-OP interface harness [Missing parts code]AN2R MCU-OP中继N-1K
7LHLDZ0062QSZ2ATEZCMCU PWB fixing plateMCU基板取付板1st lot
8LX-BZ0090QSPZAEDDCHexagon screw6角b'λ
9LHLDW086QSZZABDJCHarness ring LPDh'πr'l'p'v'LPD
10CPWBX0233QS31CDUDEMCU PWB [MX-M260 North America]MCU基板MCU基板
CPWBX0233QS32CDUDEMCU PWB [MX-M310 North America]MCU基板
CPWBX0233QS33CDUDEMCU PWB [MX-M260/M260FP/M260FG Except North America]MCU基板
CPWBX0233QS34CDUDEMCU PWB [MX-M310/M310N/M310FP/M310FG Except North America]MCU基板
CPWBX0233QS35CCUBEMCU PWB [AR-5726]MCU基板
CPWBX0233QS36CCUBEMCU PWB [AR-5731]MCU基板
11XBPS730P06KS0ABDDCScrew(3×6KS)b'λ
12LHLDZ0071QSZZAGDXCMother board holderh''-a''-b''-c''-
13CPWBN0137QSE1AZFXEMother boardh''-a''-b''-c''-
14XHBS730P0800ABDDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
15LX-BZ0082QSPZAADDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
16LHLDZ0070QSZ3AWFGCOP PWB holderOP基板b''-a''-b''-c''-
17XHBS730P0800ABDDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
18XEBS740P1000AADDCScrew(4×10)b'λ
19XBPSS730P08KS0ABDDCScrew(3×8KS)b'λ
20PSHEZ0269QSZZACDJCCCD harness sheetCCDn-πr'v't
22DHA i-0345QSZZAGDXCCCD harnessCCDn-πv
23CPWBX0140QS3KCMUWEFAX main PWB (Japan)FAXmL板基板
24CPWBN0174QS31BVMWELIU PWB (Japan)LIU基板
25RSPA00001QSPZAHDXBSpeaker (Japan)λ''-φ''
26XEPS730P06X0AADDCScrew(3×6)j''-λ''
27LSUPP0001QSZZACDJCSpacer(WLS18-0)λ''-s''-
28DHA i-0606QSPZ-BTMWCILSW interface harness 2 [Missing parts code]ILSW中继N-1K2
29CPWBX0202RS55BZTREPCL PWB [MX-M260N/M310N]PCL基板
CPWBX0202RS54CATREPCL PWB [MX-M260FP/M310FP]PCL基板
30PCAPH0018QSZZADDJD15P protect cap15P 保護b''t''
31PCAPH0019QSZZAEDJD25P protect cap (Except North America,Japan,Argentina)25P 保護b''t''
32PCAPH0017QSZZACDJD9P protect cap9P 保護b''t''
33CPWBN0135QS34-BSMWESPLC PWB [Missing parts code] [MX-M260/M310/M260FG/M310FG,AR-5726/5731]SPLC基板1st lot
35DHA i-0591QSP1-BEGNC1st delivery harness [Missing parts code](North America)1st排纸N-1k
DHA i-0601QSP1BEGNC1st delivery harness (Except North America)1st排纸N-1k
37DHA i-0200QSZZASEZCCL harnessCLn-πv
38DHA i-0347QSPZANEQCOptical sensor harness (Inch Series)光学b''v'N-1k
DHA i-0346QSPZAPEQCOptical sensor harness (AB Series)光学b''v'N-1k
39DHA i-0506QSPZAQEQCLSU interface harnessLSU中继N-1k
40DHA i-0593QSPZ-BFGNCDrive/Manual paper feed interface harness [Missing parts code]驱动/手差L中继N-1k驱动/手差L
41DHA i-0350QSPZAGDXCCassette sensor PWB harnessh''r''b''v'N-1k板N-1k
42DHA i-0610QSP1BFGNCOperation PWB FFC操作基板FFC
43DHA i-0381QSPZAHDXCFusing interface harness定着中继N-1k
44DHA i-0594QSPZ-BGGTCAN2R power supply harness [Missing parts code]AN2R 電源N-1k
55TLABH0533QSZZABDJDUSB label ANDUSBf''l'AND
56TLABH0534QSZZABDJDNIC label AND [Except MX-M260FG/M310FG]NICf''l'AND
70RDCH0161FCP1AVFGBTemperature humidity sensor温度湿度b''t''
72DHA i-0595QSPZAEDSCTemperature humidity sensor harness温度湿度b''t''
73LSUPM0002QSZZAEDJCSupport post [MX-M260N/M310N/M260FP/M310FP]f''-b''t''
74RCORF0046FCZZAHDXCCoref''
RCORF0046FCZZAHDXCCoref''
75DHA i-0597QSP1-BFGNCMCU-casette harness [Missing parts code]MCU-加T''t''
80DHA i-0590QSPZ-BTNECDV interface harness [Missing parts code]DV中继N-1k
1st lot
82VH i 29L1607DQSBBGDBMCU ROM [MX-M260 North America]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1607EQSBBGDBMCU ROM [MX-M310 North America]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1607QQSBAFXBMCU ROM [MX-M260/M260N Except North America]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1607PQSBAFXBMCU ROM [MX-M310/M310N Except North America]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1607TQSBAFXBMCU ROM [MX-M260FG/M260FP]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1607UQSBAFXBMCU ROM [MX-M310FG/M310FP]MCU ROM
VH i 29L1608MQSBAFXBMCU ROM [AR-5726]MCU ROM
83VH i 29L12856QSBHHCBPCL PRGDIMM [MX-M260N/M310N Philippines]PCL PRGDIMM
VH i 29L12858QSBHHCBPCL PRGDIMM [MX-M260N/M310N Except Philippines]PCL PRGDIMM
VH i 29L12854QSBHHCBPCL PRGDIMM [MX-M260FP/M310FP]PCL PRGDIMM

22 基板部(PWB section)
22 基板部(PWB section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEWMARKPARTRANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
84VH i 29 L 32077QSAZFQBPCL BOTDIMMJ [MX-M260N/M310N Philippines] PCLBOTDIMMJ
VH i 29 L 32079QSAZFXBPCL BOTDIMMJ [MX-M260N/M310N Except Philippines] PCLBOTDIMMJ
VH i 29 L 64012QSBDGNBPCL BOTDIMMJ [MX-M260FP/M310FP] PCLBOTDIMMJ
85LBND J0013FCZ1AEDJCBand\( {\lambda }^{ \circ } \)h*
86PSPAN0025QSZZAEDSCSpacer\( {\lambda }^{ \circ } -\frac{1}{4} - \)
87LX-BZ0024QSZZAADDCScrew\( {t}^{ \circ } \)\( \lambda \)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 第一排紙1-1b 1(1st delivery paper unit 1) - 3

23 後ル-部 (Rear frame section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1XBP SN 40 P 06 K 00-AADDCScrew(4×6K)b'λ
2DHA i - 0596QSP Z-BTMWCAN2R HL interface harness [Missing parts code]AN2R HL 中继n-λ1st lot
3TL ABZ 4868 FCZ1-ABDJDEarth label (200V Series)b'λ
4XHBS 730 P 06000-ACDDCScrew(3×6)b'λ
5LPL TM 0162QSZ1-ACDJCDrive earth plate驱動7-λ板
6LPL TM 0252QSZZ-ADDJCPaper feed earth plate LP給紙7-λ板 LP
7DHA i - 0593QSP Z-BFGNCDrive/Manual paper feed interface harness [Missing parts code]驱動/手差L 中继n-λ板1st lot
8DHA i - 0378QSP Z-ACDJCCassette earth harness加打7-λ板
9XHBS 730 P 08000-ABDDCScrew(3×8)b'λ
10XEBS 740 P 30000-ACDDCScrew(4×30)b'λ
11PG i DM 0184QSZ1-AHDXCHarness guideh-λn-λ'板"
12XEBS 740 P 30000-ACDDCScrew(4×30)b'λ
13CDA i U024RS57-AZFQE1st lift up unit1st リフ7-λ'板"
15LPL TM 0249QSZZ-ACDJC2nd earth plate2nd λ板
19QACC D7 71 3QCP Z-ATEZBAC cord (North America)AC b'λ
QACC B7 623 QCP Z-BBGDBAC cord (U,kingdom,UAE,Yemen,Oman,Qatar,Kuwait,Bahrain)AC b'λ
QACCVR 621 QCP Z-AQFQBAC cord (Germany,Switzerland,Europe,East Europe,Algeria,Iran,Egypt,Sunita,Tunisia,Nigeria,West Africa,Morocco,Jordan,Lebanon)AC b'λ
QACCZR 626 QCP Z-BBGDBAC cord (Philippines)AC b'λ
QACCZR 941 QCP Z-BBFXBAC cord (Thailand,Indonesia)AC b'λ
QACC B9 521 QCZ-AWFGBAC cord (India,Special country,Malaysia,Singapore)AC b'λ
QACC J6 41 3QCA-AYFQBAC cord (Japan)AC b'λ
QACC L6 624 QCP Z-BAFXBAC cord (Australia,New Zealand)AC b'λ
QACC R6 721 QCZZ-AZFQBAC cord (Argentina)AC b'λ
QPL GA 41 71 CCZ-AREQBPlug (India)b'λ"
QPL GA 0001 QCZ-ANEQBPlug (Special country)b'λ"
QPL GA 0009 QCP Z-AREQBPlug (Malaysia,Singapore)b'λ"
PHOG-1 023CCZZ-ABDDBPlug protector (India,Malaysia,Singapore)b'λ'用保護
TCAUS 0009QSZZ-AFDSDLAG Plug caution label (Argentina)LAG b'λ'注意"
20QSW-C9295QCP Z-ALEBBPower supply switch(AJ8W200BF)電源n-λ"
21QSW-C9294QCZ-AFDSBDehumidify heater switch (Japan)除湿7-λ'板"
22DHA i - 0589QSP Z-BSMWCDehumidify heater switch harness (Japan)除湿7-λ'板"
23DHA i - 0545QSP Z-AHDXCDehumidify heater separate harness (Japan)除湿7-λ'分岐n-λ"
24RC i LZ0016QSZZ-BEGNCReactie (200V)b'λ"
28RDENC0052QSP Z-BZTFELow voltage power supply unit (120V)低压電源n-λ"
RDENC0053QSP Z-BZTFELow voltage power supply unit (230V)低压電源n-λ"
RDENC0051QSP Z-BZTFELow voltage power supply unit (100V)低压電源n-λ"
29RDENU0058QSP Z-BNLEEHigh voltage power supply unit高压電源n-λ"
30LHL DW 1057FCZZ-ABDDCWire saddle(LWS-3S)b'λ"
31DHA i - 0588QSP Z-BFGNCAC switch harness [Missing parts code]AC n-λ"板"1st lot
LF i X-0016FCZZ-ADDJCAC cord fixing (100V Series)AC b'λ'押元
33XEBS 740 P 30000-ACDDCScrew(4×30)b'λ
34XEBS 740 P 12000-AADDCScrew(4×12)b'λ
35XWHS 740 -08100-AADDCWasherb'λ"
36XWSS 740 -10000-AADDCWasherb'λ"
37LPL TM 0349QSZZ-ASEQCPower supply fixing plate電源取付板
38NFANP 0020QSP Z-APEQBP/S fan motorPS f7-λ"
39XBPS 730 P 30KS0-ACDDCScrew(3×30KS)b'λ
42XBPS 730 P 08KS0-ABDDCScrew(3×8KS)b'λ
45LPL TM 0369QSZZ-AGDSCDelivery support angle排纸保持7-λ"
46XHB 740 P 10000-AADDCScrew(4×10)b'λ
47LSUPP 0133FCP Z-ACDJCPWB supporter基板n-λ"
49RCORF 0031QSP Z-AKDXCCoreb'λ"
50LBDN J 0013FCZ1-AEDJCBand結束n-λ"
53LHL DW 1154FCZ-ACDJCWire saddle(LWS52W)b'λ"
56LBNDJ 0037FCZ1-AADJCBand (200V Series)結束n-λ"
57PTUBP 0012QSZZ-ACDJCTube(F5×20)b'λ"
59RCORF 0004QSZZ-AFDSCCore (200V Series)b'λ"
60LBSHC 0008QSZ-ACDJCEdging(L=32) (200V Series)b'λ"
61LPL TM 0478QSZZ-AFDSCAC Inlet fixing plate (200V Series)AC l-λ"取付板
62XHSS 730 P 06000-ABDDCScrew(3×6) (200V Series)b'λ"
63NX EBS 730 P 12000-ACDDCScrew(3×12)b'λ"1st lot
64XEBS 730 P 10000-ACDDCScrew(3×10) (200V Series)b'λ"

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 第一排紙1-1b 1(1st delivery paper unit 1) - 4
23 後7l-部 (Rear frame section)

27 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1MSPRC0378QSZ1ABDJCLock spring リルフリル
2MLOKZ0001QSZZACDJCPaper guide lock チ-n-が応つロル
3XEPS730P08X00AADDCScrew(3×8X) ヤλ
4PG i DM0068QSZ1APEGCTransport paper guide 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル
5MARMP0015QSZZADDJC2nd door arm 2nd ト77-4
6NSFTZ0054QSZ1ADDJCTransport paper guide shaft 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル 油ト
7NROLP1060FCZZAFDSCU-turn roller Uケーダ-4
8MSPRP0345QSZ1ADDJCTransport paper guide spring 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル ラルの
9XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8) ヤλ
10GCÖVA0026QSTC-APEQDRight cover [Missing parts code] 右加一1st lot
11XEBS730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10) ヤλ
12PCÖVP0089QSZZADDJDPlate cover フレトカ一
13LPLTP0409QSZZACDJCSeparator plate AND2 搏きフレトAND2
14PSHEZ0515QSZZAGDXASeparator sheet 搏きドト
15NROLR0130QSZZALEBCTransport roller 搏送は一
16MSPRC0270QSZZABDJCSeparator plate spring 搏きフレト ラルの
17NBRGZ0503FCZZACDJCBearing 軸受
18LSTPP0011QSZZACDJCResin E type ring 栅脂 ELLR
19LRALP0009QSZ2APEQCCassette rail R カリルR
20XBPS730P08KS0ABDDCScrew(3×8KS) ヤλ
21NKOM-0005QSZZACDJCCassette guide collar 加ささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささ
22NSFTZ0048QSPZAFDSCCassette collar shaft 加さささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささささ
23PG i DM0074QSZZAKDXC2nd U-turn guide 2ndUケーダ-4
24XEBS740P12000AADDCScrew(4×12) ヤλ
25PSHEZ0301QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet F カルR栓钉F
26PSHEZ0302QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet R カルR栓钉R
27MSPRD0287QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller spring 絡紙補助ローラル ラルの
28NROLP0087QSZZADDJCPaper feed sub roller 絡紙補助ローラル
29NSFTZ0101QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller shaft 絡紙補助ローラル
30PSHEZ0356QSZ1AEDSCPlate cover sheet フレトカ一
31PSHEZ0347QSZ1ACDJC2nd rail R sheet 2nd しぃりR栓钉
32LPLTM0396QSZ1ADDJCSeparator guide plate 搏きフレトFR
33PSPAZ0055QSZZAADJCPlate cover spacer フレトカ一 ラルの
34LX-WZ0064FCZZAADDCPush nut(M3) ユルフリル
501CCOVP0089RS55-APEQEPlate cover unit [Missing parts code] モルフリル一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。一。 ラルの
502CG i DM0068RS55-AUEZETransport paper guide unit [Missing parts code] 搏送 チ-n-が応つロル ダルの
503CPLTP0409RS51ANEGCSeparation plate unit 分離フレト工部
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521

27 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section) - 1

25 2nd 550 1t (2nd 550 cassette unit)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1LPLTP0159QSZZADDJCCassette rear edge plate 保後端板
2LHLDW1226FCZZABDJCTurn fastener トフフフフ
3LPLTM0179QSZ1AREQCRotation plate 回軸板
4PSHEZ0274QSZZACDJCRotation plate sheet 回軸板←ト
5GCAS0005QSZ4BAGDD550 cassette 550 豉伏
6PGiDM0070QSZ1AMEGCGuide F 保伏F
7PTPE-0021QSZ1-AADJCGID tape [Missing parts code] GID 两面→F1st lot
8LPLTM0181QSZ1ABDJCSide plate guide F 侧板"伏F
9PGiDM0071QSZALEBCGuide R 保伏R
10LX-BZ1144FCPZAADDCScrew 保λ
11NGERH0193FCZZABDDCUC manual paper feed gear UC手差←捷
12MSPRC2631FCZZACDJCFusing pressure spring 定着加压 ムリル
13MLEVP0755FCZ1AEDJCSide plate F lever 侧板F←-
14LX-BZ0833FCPZACDDCScrew 保λ
15CSHEZ0244QS02AEDJC2nd cassette sheet ASS'Y 2nd応伏ト組品
16XRESP70-08000AADDCE type ring(E7) E リフ伏
17NGERH0108QSZZADDJCLift gear(22T) 保伏
18MSPRC0354QSZZACDJCLift gear spring 保伏 水伏
19NSFTZ0047QSZ1AKEBCLift shaft トフフ伏
20LPLTM0180QSZ1AEDSCLift plate トフ伏
21NBRGP0041GCZZADDJCBearing 軸受
22XEBS74010000AADDCScrew(4×10) 保λ
23JHNDP0012QSZZAUEZC2nd cassette panel AN2R 2nd応伏ト ミル AN2R
24XBPS740P08KS0ABDDCScrew(4×8KS) 保λ
25GCōV-0282FCZZAHDXDCassette handle cover P2 保伏 取手伏 -P2
26PSHEZ5948FCZZADDJCCassette handle sheet P2 保伏 取手伏 P2
27LPLTM0277QSZZACDJCSide plate guide R 侧板"伏R
28XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8) 保λ
29TCADZ0549QSZZ-AEDSDSize display card [Missing parts code](Inch Series) 保伏 表示→1st lot
TCADZ0550QSZZAEDSCSize display label (AB Series except Japan) 保伏 表示→
TCADZ0551QSZZAEDSCSize display label (Japan) 保伏 表示→
501CCASP0005RS79-BFGNE2nd 550 cassette unit [Missing parts code] 2nd 550 豉伏 ミ伏1st lot
(Unit)
901CCASP0005RS59BKHCE2nd 550 cassette unit(Without No.30) 2nd 550 豉伏 ミ伏 (No.30を除く)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section) - 2
2nd 550 (2nd 550 cassette unit)

26 2nd 結紙部 (2nd paper feed section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
2PCOVP 0070QSZZADDJDSensor coverせりト加一
4CPWBFO095QSE3APEQE2nd cassette sensor PWB2nd イリルデー基板
5MLEVP 0063QSZ1ADDJCUpper limit detect actuator上限検知700000-
6MLEVP 0064QSZZADDJCPaper detect actuator紙検知700000-
7MLEVP 0062QSZZACDJCP-IN detect actuator入紙検知700000-
8PCOVP 0064QSZZADDJDSolenoid coverルフドク一
9RPLU-0026QSZ1AREQBPaper feed solenoid給紙ルフド
RPLU-0026QSP11AREQBPaper feed solenoid給紙ルフド
10MARMP 0026QSZZADDJCSolenoid armルフドク一
11MSPRC0209QSZ1ACDJCSolenoid springルフドクリツ
13NSFTZ0102QSZZAHDXC2nd paper feed roller shaft2nd 結紙ローナーベ轴
14QSW-B0017QSZZAFDSBTray detect switchトレ検知700000-
17DHA i-0397QSPZADDJCCassette detect interface harnessカト検知中縫ハス
18NBRGC0100FCZ1ACDJCBearing 6^7000^6
19MSPRD0389QSZZACDJCPick up roller pressure spring^7000^7-加压7000^7-
20MARMP 0021QSZZADDJCPick up arm R^7000^7-7-4R
21NGERH0107QSZZADDJCPaper feed gear(20T)給紙状+
22LPiN-0026MCZZAADDCSpring pin(φ2-8)^7000^7-
23NROLR0132QSZ1AREQCPaper feed roller AND2給紙ローナ-AND2
24MARMP 0019QSZZADDJCPick up arm F^7000^7-7-4F
26NGERH0990FCZZABDJCGear(16T)^7000^7-
27NROLR0133QSZZACDJCPaper feed in detect actuator spring入紙検知700000-
29DHA i-0394QSPZADDJCDoor open/close detect harness7開閉検知ハス
30MSPRD0204QSZZACDJCPaper feed in detect actuator spring入紙検知700000-
31DHA i-0473QSP1AGDXCCassette sensor PWB harnessカト検知基板ハス

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section) - 3
26 2nd給紙部(2ndpaperfeedsection)

27 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1MSPRC0378QSZ1ABDJCLock spring リルフリル
2MLOKZ0001QSZZACDJCPaper guide lock チ-n-が応つロル
3XEPS730P08X00AADDCScrew(3×8X) ヤλ
4PG i DM0068QSZ1APEGCTransport paper guide 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル
5MARMP0015QSZZADDJC2nd door arm 2nd ト77-4
6NSFTZ0054QSZ1ADDJCTransport paper guide shaft 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル 油状
7NROLP1060FCZZAFDSCU-turn roller Uケーダ-4
8MSPRP0345QSZ1ADDJCTransport paper guide spring 搬送 チ-n-が応つロル ラルの
9XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8) ヤλ
10GCÖVA0026QSTC-APEQDRight cover [Missing parts code] 右加一1st lot
11XEBS730P10000ACDDCScrew(3×10) ヤλ
12PCÖVP0089QSZZADDJDPlate cover フレトカ一
13LPLTP0409QSZZACDJCSeparator plate AND2 搏きフレトAND2
14PSHEZ0515QSZZAGDXASeparator sheet 搏きけ口
15NROLR0130QSZZALEBCTransport roller 搏送は一
16MSPRC0270QSZZABDJCSeparator plate spring 搏きフレト ラルの
17NBRGZ0503FCZZACDJCBearing 軸受
18LSTPP0011QSZZACDJCResin E type ring 栅脂 ELLK
19LRALP0009QSZ2APEQCCassette rail R カリルR
20XBPS730P08KS0ABDDCScrew(3×8KS) ヤλ
21NKOM-0005QSZZACDJCCassette guide collar 加さ鉄鉄
22NSFTZ0048QSPZAFDSCCassette collar shaft 加さ鉄鉄
23PG i DM0074QSZZAKDXC2nd U-turn guide 2ndUケーダ-4
24XEBS740P12000AADDCScrew(4×12) ヤλ
25PSHEZ0301QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet F カルR ハルのFUT
26PSHEZ0302QSZZACDJCRail R side sheet R カルR ハルのRUT
27MSPRD0287QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller spring 絡紙補助ローラルの
28NROLP0087QSZZADDJCPaper feed sub roller 絡紙補助ローラ尔
29NSFTZ0101QSZZACDJCPaper feed sub roller shaft 絡紙補助ローラル
30PSHEZ0356QSZ1AEDSCPlate cover sheet フレトカ一
31PSHEZ0347QSZ1ACDJC2nd rail R sheet 2nd しぃ鉄鉄RUT
32LPLTM0396QSZ1ADDJCSeparator guide plate 搏きフレトAND1
33PSPAZ0055QSZZAADJCPlate cover spacer フレトカ一 東-ルの
34LX-WZ0064FCZZAADDCPush nut(M3) ユルフリル
501CCOVP0089RS55-APEQEPlate cover unit [Missing parts code] モルフリル一。1st lot
502CG i DM0068RS55-AUEZETransport paper guide unit [Missing parts code] 搏送 チ-n-が応つロル ヨルの1st lot
503CPLTP0409RS51ANEGESeparation plate unit 分離フレト工社

27 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section) - 1

28 2nd 驱動部 (2nd drive section)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEWMARKPARTRANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1PCOVP 0084QSZZAEDJC2nd bottom cover2nd 底加-
2CPWBF 0228QSE1AXFGE2nd cassette interface PWB2nd 加下中继基板
3XEBS730P08000ACDDCScrew(3×8)6
4DHA i - 0597QSP1-BFGNC2nd multi step harness[Missing parts code]1st lot
5NBRGC0100FCZ1ACDJCBearing 66
6MARMP 0018QSZZADDJCBody joint arm本体連結7-4
7PCLC-0031QSZZ-AQEQB2nd paper feed clutch(42T)[Missing parts code]1st lot
8XRESP40-06000AADDCE type ring(E4)E リル*
9XRESP50-06000AADDCE type ring(E5)E リル*
10MSPRT0203QSZZACDJCJoint spring連結λリル*
11NGERH0119QSZZADDJCGear(36T)7*
12NGERH1207FCZZAFDSCJoint gear(40T)連結*
13CDA i U024RS58AZFQE2nd lift up unit2nd リフーラフ ハチ
14XEBS740P30000ACDDCScrew(4×30)7*
15XEBS740P12000AADDCScrew(4×12)7*
17DHA i - 0474QSP1-BSMWCLUM harnessLUM ルル
20LPLTM0203QSZ1AFDSCMulti step drive plate多段驅動レト
24NGERH0121QSZZAEDJCGear(20T/45T/26P)7*
25NBLTT0029QSZZAGDXBVertical transport belt縄搬送*
26PCLC-0020QSZZAXFGBTransport clutch搬送効力
28NPLYZ0027QSZZADDJCVertical transport pulley縄搬送効力-
29PSHEZ0250QSZZABDJCFlange sheet法兰*
30NROLP0008QSZZADDJCPulley7-1-
31PSHEZ0249QSZZABDJCFlange sheet法兰*
32NBRGC0529FCZZADDJCBearing軸受
33LPLTM0176QSZ1AHEBCClutch earth plate法兰*板
34PSHEZ0556QSZZACDJCHarness holder sheetハス押元ト

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 2nd 搬送部 (2nd paper transfer section) - 2
28 2nd 驱動部 (2nd drive section)

37 棍包及付属品(Packing material & accessories)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changPRICE RANKNEW MARKPART RANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
2TINSE2026QSZZAYFQDOperation manual [MX-M260/M310 English(North America)] 取拔說明書
TINSE2078QSZZBDGNDOperation manual [English(Except North America,U.Kingdom)] 取拔說明書
TINSE2090QSZZ-BGGXDOperation manual [Missing parts code] [MX-M Series English(U.Kingdom)] 取拔說明書1st lot
TINSG2088QSZZ-BDGNDOperation manual [Missing parts code] [German(Germany,Switzerland)] 取拔說明書1st lot
TINSJ2031QSZZAYFQDOperation manual [Japanese] 取拔說明書
TINSE2027QSZZAKDXDOperation manual(Copy/SPLC install guide) [English] 取拔說明書
TINSE2083QSZZAYFQDOperation manual(Copy/PCL install guide) [English MX-M260N/M310N] 取拔說明書
TINSG2089QSZZ-AREQDOperation manual(Copy/SPLC install guide) [Missing parts code] [German(Germany,Switzerland)] 取拔說明書1st lot
TINSJ2032QSZZAKEBDOperation manual(Copy/SPLC install guide) [Japanese MX-M260FG/M310FG] 取拔說明書
TINSJ2033QSZZANEQDOperation manual(Copy/SPLC install guide) [Japanese MX-M260FP/M310FP] 取拔說明書
TINSJ2034QSZZAWFGDOperation manual(FAX) [Japanese] 取拔說明書
CDSKA0261QS31AHDXDCD-ROM [MX-M260 North America] CD-ROM
CDSKA0264QS31-ALEBDCD-ROM [Missing parts code] [MX-M Series(Except North America)] CD-ROM1st lot
CDSKA0265QS31ALEBDCD-ROM(PDL DISK1) [MX-M260N/M310N] CD-ROM
CDSKA0266QS31ALEBDCD-ROM(PDL DISK2) [MX-M260N/M310N] CD-ROM
CDSKA0267QS31ALEBDCD-ROM [MX-M260FG/M310FG] CD-ROM
CDSKA0268QS31ALEBDCD-ROM [MX-M260FP/M310FP] CD-ROM
TCADZ0049QSZZAHDXDInstallation report card (Germany,Switzerland,Europe,East Europe) 設置報告書
TCADS1693FCZZAADSDInstallation report card (Japan) 設置報告書
TCADZ0098QSZZAFDSDWarranty card SUK (U.kingdom) 保証かト'SUK
CCADZ1518FC01ABDJDMaintenance card EX [MX-M260/M260N/M310N,AR-5726/5731] ナフクト'EX
CCADZ1561FC01AKDXDMaintenance card J [MX-M260FG/M260FP/M310FG] ナフクト'J
TGANE1001QCZBACDJDSCA warranty (Australia,New Zealand) SCA 保證書
QCNWG0013QSZZAFDSCLine cable (Japan) ナフクト'IL
TKEI0001QSZZAEDJDCounter contract card (Japan) 加藤-契約書
7SPAKA0484QSZZBEGNDBottom packing case (Japan) 底がス
8LX-BZ0015QSPZAFDSC2/3 fixing screw 2/3固定ごス
9TCADZ0010QSZZACDJDFixing screw caution card 固定ごス 注意ごス
10LHLDW1226FCZZABDJCTurn fastener 報表変態
11TCADZ1275FCZZABDJDCassette rotation tag はり回転け
12SSAKA3001CCZZAADDDVinyl bag(140×360) (North America,Japan,Argentina) ボリ袋
SSAKA5003CCZZAADDDVinyl bag(140×260) (Except North America,Japan) ボリ袋
13SSAKA2343QCZZAADDDVinyl bag(260×380) ボリ袋
14SPAKA0134RSZZALEBDOC protect sheet OC 保護けト
15LBNDC0075FCZZABDJCAC cord band (Except North America,Japan,India, Special country,Philippines,Malaysia,Singapore) AC ナフクト"
UBNDA0001FCZZAADDCAC cord band (India,Special country,Malaysia, Singapore,Argentina) AC ナフクト"
17SPAKA3914FCZZACDJDDV sleeve (Japan) DV ナフ"
19TLABZ0106RSZZAFDSDLAG 4 label (Argentina) LAG4 ナフ"

37 棍包及付属品(Packing material & accessories)

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 棍包及付属品(Packing material &amp; accessories) - 1

PRP03937

38 MX-VR10 棍包及付属品 (MX-VR10 Packing material & accessories)
38 MX-VR10 棍包及付属品 (MX-VR10 Packing material & accessories)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEWMARKPARTRANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1GCÖV-0 075QSZ1BBGDDOC coverOC 加* -
2GCÖV-0 247FCZZASEQDOC stockerOC ストウェー
3PCUSS0 032QSZZAWFGCOC matOC マフ
4MHNG-0 025QSTZBCGDCOC hinge ROC ハング * R
5XWVS740-05000AADDCWasherウashi
6XEBS740P12000AADDCScrew(4×12)ビス
7MHNG-0 026QSTZBCGDCOC hinge LOC ハング * L
14SSAKH3012KCZZADDJDVinyl bagロリ袋
(Unit)
901CCÖV-0 075RS53-BKHCEOC cover unitOC 加*-�イ卜

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 棍包及付属品(Packing material &amp; accessories) - 2

39 MX-RP10 棍包及付属品 (MX-RP10 Packing material & accessories)
39 MX-RP10 棍包及付属品 (MX-RP10 Packing material & accessories)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEWMARKPARTRANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1SPAKA0088QSZZAEDSDProtect packing sheet保護�� !
2CFiX-0012RS54AUEZESPF glass fixing plate unitSPF イ�ルト
3SSAKZ0004QSZZAADDDVinyl bag(80×450)木袋
6SSAKH3012KCZZADDJDVinyl bag木袋
7SPAKA0488QSZZBKHGDAdd Rト*R
9SPAKA0487QSZZBFGNDAdd Lト*L
10LSOU-0041QST1APEQCMiddle tray中間トリ
11SSAKA1341QCZZAADDDVinyl bag(180×380)木袋
12SPAK-545ECCZZAADDDVinyl bag静電木袋
14SPAKA0622QSZZAGDXDOC mat fixing addOC マフ固定材
15CCLEZ0020QS01AKEBDSPF glass cleanerSPF イスリーナー
16TLABS3760FCZZACDJDCE labelCE フロー

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 棍包及付属品(Packing material &amp; accessories) - 3

40 MX-TR11 棍包及付属品 (MX-TR11 Packing material & accessories)
40 MX-TR11 棍包及付属品 (MX-TR11 Packing material & accessories)

NO.PARTS CODEInter-changesePRICE RANKNEWMARKPARTRANKDESCRIPTIONTR No.Effective time
Ex.Ja.
1X E B S 7 4 0 P 1 0 0 0 0AADDCScrew(4×10)匕'λ
2X H B S 7 4 0 P 1 0 0 0 0AADDCScrew(4×10)匕'λ
3SS A K A 0 0 0 6 U C Z ZAADDDVinyl bag(50×60)木'袋
4L H L D Z 0 1 4 9 Q S Z ZAHDXC2nd delivery holder第2排紙札の-
7SS A K - 4 2 7 1 C C Z ZADDJDVinyl bag(420×690)木'袋
9SS A K A 2 5 4 0 Q C Z ZABDDDVinyl bag(260×560)木'袋
10N PSHEZ 0 6 6 5 Q S Z Z-ACDJCOptical frame sheet光学レーパー-09/08 Mid

SHARP MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV - 棍包及付属品(Packing material &amp; accessories) - 4

SHARP

Table of contents Cliquez un titre pour y accéder
Manual assistant
Powered by ChatGPT
Waiting for your message
Product information

Brand : SHARP

Model : MX 2640 & MX-2640N/3140N/3640N,MV

Category : Printer